blob: 549c57633a432ac1c146ab6a6e373001658068f0 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000039#include "llvm/LLVMContext.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000040#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000041#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000042#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +000043#include "llvm/Operator.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000044#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +000045#include "llvm/Analysis/MallocHelper.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000046#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000047#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
48#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
49#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000051#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Torok Edwin7d696d82009-07-11 13:10:19 +000053#include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000054#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000055#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000056#include "llvm/Support/IRBuilder.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000057#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000058#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Daniel Dunbarce63ffb2009-07-25 00:23:56 +000059#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000060#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000061#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000062#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000063#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000064#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000065#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000066#include <climits>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000067using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000068using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000069
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000070STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
71STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
72STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
73STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
74STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000075
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000076namespace {
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000077 /// InstCombineWorklist - This is the worklist management logic for
78 /// InstCombine.
79 class InstCombineWorklist {
80 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
81 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
82
83 void operator=(const InstCombineWorklist&RHS); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
84 InstCombineWorklist(const InstCombineWorklist&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
85 public:
86 InstCombineWorklist() {}
87
88 bool isEmpty() const { return Worklist.empty(); }
89
90 /// Add - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it isn't already
91 /// in it.
92 void Add(Instruction *I) {
Jeffrey Yasskin43069632009-10-08 00:12:24 +000093 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second) {
94 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ADD: " << *I << '\n');
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000095 Worklist.push_back(I);
Jeffrey Yasskin43069632009-10-08 00:12:24 +000096 }
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000097 }
98
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +000099 void AddValue(Value *V) {
100 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
101 Add(I);
102 }
103
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000104 // Remove - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +0000105 void Remove(Instruction *I) {
106 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
107 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
108
109 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
110 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
111
112 WorklistMap.erase(It);
113 }
114
115 Instruction *RemoveOne() {
116 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
117 Worklist.pop_back();
118 WorklistMap.erase(I);
119 return I;
120 }
121
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +0000122 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
123 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
124 /// now.
125 ///
126 void AddUsersToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
127 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
128 UI != UE; ++UI)
129 Add(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
130 }
131
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +0000132
133 /// Zap - check that the worklist is empty and nuke the backing store for
134 /// the map if it is large.
135 void Zap() {
136 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
137
138 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
139 WorklistMap.clear();
140 }
141 };
142} // end anonymous namespace.
143
144
145namespace {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000146 /// InstCombineIRInserter - This is an IRBuilder insertion helper that works
147 /// just like the normal insertion helper, but also adds any new instructions
148 /// to the instcombine worklist.
149 class InstCombineIRInserter : public IRBuilderDefaultInserter<true> {
150 InstCombineWorklist &Worklist;
151 public:
152 InstCombineIRInserter(InstCombineWorklist &WL) : Worklist(WL) {}
153
154 void InsertHelper(Instruction *I, const Twine &Name,
155 BasicBlock *BB, BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt) const {
156 IRBuilderDefaultInserter<true>::InsertHelper(I, Name, BB, InsertPt);
157 Worklist.Add(I);
158 }
159 };
160} // end anonymous namespace
161
162
163namespace {
Chris Lattner3e8b6632009-09-02 06:11:42 +0000164 class InstCombiner : public FunctionPass,
165 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000166 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +0000167 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +0000168 bool MadeIRChange;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000169 public:
Chris Lattner75551f72009-08-30 17:53:59 +0000170 /// Worklist - All of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000171 InstCombineWorklist Worklist;
172
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000173 /// Builder - This is an IRBuilder that automatically inserts new
174 /// instructions into the worklist when they are created.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +0000175 typedef IRBuilder<true, ConstantFolder, InstCombineIRInserter> BuilderTy;
176 BuilderTy *Builder;
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000177
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +0000178 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000179 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID), TD(0), Builder(0) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +0000180
Owen Andersone922c022009-07-22 00:24:57 +0000181 LLVMContext *Context;
182 LLVMContext *getContext() const { return Context; }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000183
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000184 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000185 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000186
187 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000188
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000189 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000190 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000191 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000192 }
193
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000194 TargetData *getTargetData() const { return TD; }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000195
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000196 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
197 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
198 // Return Value:
199 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000200 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000201 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000202 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000203 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000204 Instruction *visitFAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000205 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000206 Instruction *visitFSub(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000207 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000208 Instruction *visitFMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000209 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
210 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
211 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000212 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000213 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
214 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000215 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
216 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
217 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
218 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
219 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +0000220 Instruction *FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +0000221 Instruction *FoldAndOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS, FCmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000222 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +0000223 Instruction *FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +0000224 Instruction *FoldOrOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS, FCmpInst *RHS);
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +0000225 Instruction *FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +0000226 Value *A, Value *B, Value *C);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000227 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
228 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000229 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
230 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
231 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
232 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000233 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
234 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000235 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
236 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
237 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000238 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
239 Instruction *LHS,
240 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000241 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
242 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000243
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +0000244 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(GEPOperator *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000245 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000246 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000247 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000248 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
249 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000250 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000251 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
252 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
253 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000254 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000255 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000256 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
257 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000258 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
259 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000260 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(PtrToIntInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000261 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000262 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000263 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
264 Instruction *FI);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +0000265 Instruction *FoldSelectIntoOp(SelectInst &SI, Value*, Value*);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000266 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
267 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000268 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
269 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000270 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
271 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000272 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000273 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000274 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000275 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000276 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000277 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000278 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000279 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000280 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000281 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000282
283 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000284 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000285
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000286 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000287 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000288 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000289 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000290 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
291 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000292 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +0000293 DbgDeclareInst *hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Value *V);
294
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000295
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000296 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000297 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
298 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
299 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000300 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000301 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
302 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000303 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
304 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000305 Worklist.Add(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000306 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000307 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000308
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000309 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
310 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
311 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
312 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
313 // modified.
314 //
315 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +0000316 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000317
318 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
319 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
320 if (&I == V)
321 V = UndefValue::get(I.getType());
322
323 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
324 return &I;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000325 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000326
327 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
328 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
329 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
330 // this function.
331 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +0000332 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ERASE " << I << '\n');
Chris Lattner931f8f32009-08-31 05:17:58 +0000333
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000334 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000335 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
336 // use counts.
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +0000337 if (I.getNumOperands() < 8) {
338 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
339 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
340 Worklist.Add(Op);
341 }
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000342 Worklist.Remove(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000343 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +0000344 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000345 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
346 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000347
348 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
349 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
350 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
351 }
352
353 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
354 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
355 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
356 }
357 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
358 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
359 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000360
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000361 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000362
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000363 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
364 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000365 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000366
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000367 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
368 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
369 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
370
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000371 /// SimplifyDemandedUseBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value
372 /// based on the demanded bits.
373 Value *SimplifyDemandedUseBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
374 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
375 unsigned Depth);
376 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Use &U, APInt DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000377 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000378 unsigned Depth=0);
379
380 /// SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits - Inst is an integer instruction that
381 /// SimplifyDemandedBits knows about. See if the instruction has any
382 /// properties that allow us to simplify its operands.
383 bool SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(Instruction &Inst);
384
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +0000385 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, APInt DemandedElts,
386 APInt& UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000387
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +0000388 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator, cast instruction, or select
389 // which has a PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction
390 // into the PHI (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are
391 // constants).
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +0000392 //
393 // If AllowAggressive is true, FoldOpIntoPhi will allow certain transforms
394 // that would normally be unprofitable because they strongly encourage jump
395 // threading.
396 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I, bool AllowAggressive = false);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000397
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000398 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
399 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
400 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
401 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000402 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +0000403 Instruction *FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
404
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000405
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000406 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
407 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000408
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000409 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000410 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000411 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000412 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000413 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000414 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000415 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000416 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000417 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000418
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000419
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000420 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000421
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000422 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +0000423 unsigned CastOpc, int &NumCastsRemoved);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000424 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
425 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000426
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000427 };
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +0000428} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000429
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000430char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
431static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
432X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
433
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000434// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000435// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Dan Gohman14ef4f02009-08-29 23:39:38 +0000436static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000437 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000438 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) ||
439 BinaryOperator::isFNeg(V) ||
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000440 BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000441 return 3;
442 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000443 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000444 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
445 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000446}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000447
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000448// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
449// it.
450static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000451 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000452}
453
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000454// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
455// though a va_arg area...
456static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000457 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
458 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000459 return Type::getInt32Ty(Ty->getContext());
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000460 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000461 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000462}
463
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000464/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
465/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
466/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000467static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
Dan Gohman016de812009-07-17 23:55:56 +0000468 if (Operator *O = dyn_cast<Operator>(V)) {
469 if (O->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
470 return O->getOperand(0);
471 if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(V))
472 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
473 return GEP->getPointerOperand();
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000474 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000475 return 0;
476}
477
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000478/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
479/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000480static Instruction::CastOps
481isEliminableCastPair(
482 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
483 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
484 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
485 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
486) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000487
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000488 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
489 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000490
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000491 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
492 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
493 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000494
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000495 unsigned Res = CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000496 DstTy,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000497 TD ? TD->getIntPtrType(CI->getContext()) : 0);
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000498
499 // We don't want to form an inttoptr or ptrtoint that converts to an integer
500 // type that differs from the pointer size.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000501 if ((Res == Instruction::IntToPtr &&
Dan Gohman5e9bb732009-08-19 23:38:22 +0000502 (!TD || SrcTy != TD->getIntPtrType(CI->getContext()))) ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000503 (Res == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
Dan Gohman5e9bb732009-08-19 23:38:22 +0000504 (!TD || DstTy != TD->getIntPtrType(CI->getContext()))))
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000505 Res = 0;
506
507 return Instruction::CastOps(Res);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000508}
509
510/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
511/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
512/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000513static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
514 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000515 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
516
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000517 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000518 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000519 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000520 return false;
521 return true;
522}
523
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000524// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
525// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000526//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000527// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
528// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
529// binary operators.
530//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000531// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
532// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000533//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000534bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000535 bool Changed = false;
Dan Gohman14ef4f02009-08-29 23:39:38 +0000536 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000537 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000538
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000539 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
540 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000541 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
542 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
543 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000544 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000545 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
546 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000547 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
548 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
549 return true;
550 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
551 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
552 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
553 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
554 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
555
556 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000557 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000558 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000559 Op1->getOperand(0),
560 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000561 Worklist.Add(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000562 I.setOperand(0, New);
563 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
564 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000565 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000566 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000567 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000568}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000569
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000570/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
571/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
572/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
573bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
Dan Gohman14ef4f02009-08-29 23:39:38 +0000574 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000575 return false;
576 I.swapOperands();
577 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
578 return true;
579}
580
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000581// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
582// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000583//
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000584static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000585 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000586 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000587
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000588 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
589 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000590 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000591
592 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
593 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000594 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000595
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000596 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000597}
598
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000599// dyn_castFNegVal - Given a 'fsub' instruction, return the RHS of the
600// instruction if the LHS is a constant negative zero (which is the 'negate'
601// form).
602//
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000603static inline Value *dyn_castFNegVal(Value *V) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000604 if (BinaryOperator::isFNeg(V))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000605 return BinaryOperator::getFNegArgument(V);
606
607 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
608 if (ConstantFP *C = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000609 return ConstantExpr::getFNeg(C);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000610
611 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
612 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isFloatingPoint())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000613 return ConstantExpr::getFNeg(C);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000614
615 return 0;
616}
617
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000618static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000619 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000620 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000621
622 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000623 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000624 return ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), ~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000625 return 0;
626}
627
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000628// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
629// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000630// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
631// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000632//
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000633static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000634 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000635 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000636 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000637 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000638 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000639 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000640 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000641 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000642 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000643 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000644 CST = ConstantInt::get(V->getType()->getContext(),
645 APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000646 return I->getOperand(0);
647 }
648 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000649 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000650}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000651
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000652/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000653static Constant *AddOne(Constant *C) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000654 return ConstantExpr::getAdd(C,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +0000655 ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000656}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000657/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000658static Constant *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000659 return ConstantExpr::getSub(C,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +0000660 ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000661}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000662/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
663/// this size.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000664static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000665 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
666 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
667 if (sign) {
668 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
669 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
670 } else {
671 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
672 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
673 }
674
675 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
676
677 if (sign) {
678 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
679 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
680 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
681 } else
682 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
683}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000684
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000685
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000686/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
687/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
688/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
689/// constant and return true.
690static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000691 APInt Demanded) {
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000692 assert(I && "No instruction?");
693 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
694
695 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
696 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
697 if (!OpC) return false;
698
699 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
700 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
701 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
702 return false;
703
704 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
705 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000706 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(OpC->getType(), Demanded));
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000707 return true;
708}
709
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000710// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
711// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
712// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
713// min/max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000714static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000715 const APInt& KnownOne,
716 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000717 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == KnownOne.getBitWidth() &&
718 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Min.getBitWidth() &&
719 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Max.getBitWidth() &&
720 "KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000721 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000722
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000723 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
724 // bit if it is unknown.
725 Min = KnownOne;
726 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
727
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000728 if (UnknownBits.isNegative()) { // Sign bit is unknown
729 Min.set(Min.getBitWidth()-1);
730 Max.clear(Max.getBitWidth()-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000731 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000732}
733
734// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
735// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
736// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
737// min/max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000738static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const APInt &KnownZero,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000739 const APInt &KnownOne,
740 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000741 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == KnownOne.getBitWidth() &&
742 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Min.getBitWidth() &&
743 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Max.getBitWidth() &&
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000744 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000745 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000746
747 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
748 Min = KnownOne;
749 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
750 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
751}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000752
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000753/// SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits - Inst is an integer instruction that
754/// SimplifyDemandedBits knows about. See if the instruction has any
755/// properties that allow us to simplify its operands.
756bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(Instruction &Inst) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000757 unsigned BitWidth = Inst.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000758 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
759 APInt DemandedMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
760
761 Value *V = SimplifyDemandedUseBits(&Inst, DemandedMask,
762 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0);
763 if (V == 0) return false;
764 if (V == &Inst) return true;
765 ReplaceInstUsesWith(Inst, V);
766 return true;
767}
768
769/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This form of SimplifyDemandedBits simplifies the
770/// specified instruction operand if possible, updating it in place. It returns
771/// true if it made any change and false otherwise.
772bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Use &U, APInt DemandedMask,
773 APInt &KnownZero, APInt &KnownOne,
774 unsigned Depth) {
775 Value *NewVal = SimplifyDemandedUseBits(U.get(), DemandedMask,
776 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
777 if (NewVal == 0) return false;
Dan Gohmane41a1152009-10-05 16:31:55 +0000778 U = NewVal;
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000779 return true;
780}
781
782
783/// SimplifyDemandedUseBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
784/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000785/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
786/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
787/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
788/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
789/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000790/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000791/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
792/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
793/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
794/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
795/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
796/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
797/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000798///
799/// This returns null if it did not change anything and it permits no
800/// simplification. This returns V itself if it did some simplification of V's
801/// operands based on the information about what bits are demanded. This returns
802/// some other non-null value if it found out that V is equal to another value
803/// in the context where the specified bits are demanded, but not for all users.
804Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedUseBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
805 APInt &KnownZero, APInt &KnownOne,
806 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000807 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
808 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
809 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000810 const Type *VTy = V->getType();
811 assert((TD || !isa<PointerType>(VTy)) &&
812 "SimplifyDemandedBits needs to know bit widths!");
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000813 assert((!TD || TD->getTypeSizeInBits(VTy->getScalarType()) == BitWidth) &&
814 (!VTy->isIntOrIntVector() ||
815 VTy->getScalarSizeInBits() == BitWidth) &&
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000816 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000817 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000818 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne "
819 "must have same BitWidth");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000820 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
821 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
822 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
823 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000824 return 0;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000825 }
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000826 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(V)) {
827 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
828 KnownOne.clear();
829 KnownZero = DemandedMask;
830 return 0;
831 }
832
Chris Lattner08d2cc72009-01-31 07:26:06 +0000833 KnownZero.clear();
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000834 KnownOne.clear();
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000835 if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
836 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
837 return 0;
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +0000838 return UndefValue::get(VTy);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000839 }
840
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000841 if (Depth == 6) // Limit search depth.
842 return 0;
843
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000844 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
845 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
846
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000847 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
848 if (!I) {
849 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
850 return 0; // Only analyze instructions.
851 }
852
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000853 // If there are multiple uses of this value and we aren't at the root, then
854 // we can't do any simplifications of the operands, because DemandedMask
855 // only reflects the bits demanded by *one* of the users.
856 if (Depth != 0 && !I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000857 // Despite the fact that we can't simplify this instruction in all User's
858 // context, we can at least compute the knownzero/knownone bits, and we can
859 // do simplifications that apply to *just* the one user if we know that
860 // this instruction has a simpler value in that context.
861 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
862 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
863 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
864 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
865 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
866 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
867
868 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
869 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and' in this
870 // context.
871 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
872 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
873 return I->getOperand(0);
874 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
875 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
876 return I->getOperand(1);
877
878 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
879 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +0000880 return Constant::getNullValue(VTy);
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000881
882 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
883 // We can simplify (X|Y) -> X or Y in the user's context if we know that
884 // only bits from X or Y are demanded.
885
886 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
887 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
888 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
889 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
890 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
891
892 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the
893 // other. These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or' in this
894 // context.
895 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
896 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
897 return I->getOperand(0);
898 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
899 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
900 return I->getOperand(1);
901
902 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
903 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
904 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
905 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
906 return I->getOperand(0);
907 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
908 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
909 return I->getOperand(1);
910 }
911
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000912 // Compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
913 ComputeMaskedBits(I, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
914 return 0;
915 }
916
917 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
918 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits so that we can try to simplify the
919 // operands. This allows visitTruncInst (for example) to simplify the
920 // operand of a trunc without duplicating all the logic below.
921 if (Depth == 0 && !V->hasOneUse())
922 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
923
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000924 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000925 default:
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000926 ComputeMaskedBits(I, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000927 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000928 case Instruction::And:
929 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000930 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
931 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
932 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000933 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000934 return I;
935 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
936 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000937
938 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
939 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
940 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
941 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000942 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000943 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
944 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000945 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000946
947 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
948 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +0000949 return Constant::getNullValue(VTy);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000950
951 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000952 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000953 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000954
955 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
956 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
957 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
958 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
959 break;
960 case Instruction::Or:
961 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000962 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
963 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
964 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000965 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000966 return I;
967 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
968 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000969
970 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
971 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
972 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
973 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000974 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000975 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
976 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000977 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000978
979 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
980 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
981 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
982 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000983 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000984 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
985 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000986 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000987
988 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000989 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000990 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000991
992 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
993 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
994 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
995 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
996 break;
997 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000998 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
999 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1000 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001001 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001002 return I;
1003 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1004 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001005
1006 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1007 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
1008 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001009 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001010 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001011 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001012
1013 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1014 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1015 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1016 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1017 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1018 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1019
1020 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1021 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1022 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattner95afdfe2009-08-31 04:36:22 +00001023 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1024 Instruction *Or =
1025 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1026 I->getName());
1027 return InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1028 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001029
1030 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1031 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1032 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1033 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1034 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1035 // all known
1036 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
Dan Gohman43ee5f72009-08-03 22:07:33 +00001037 Constant *AndC = Constant::getIntegerValue(VTy,
1038 ~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001039 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001040 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001041 return InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001042 }
1043 }
1044
1045 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1046 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001047 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001048 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001049
1050 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1051 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1052 break;
1053 }
1054 case Instruction::Select:
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001055 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(2), DemandedMask,
1056 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1057 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001058 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001059 return I;
1060 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1061 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001062
1063 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001064 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask) ||
1065 ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001066 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001067
1068 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1069 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1070 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1071 break;
1072 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001073 unsigned truncBf = I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001074 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1075 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1076 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001077 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001078 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001079 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001080 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1081 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1082 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001083 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001084 break;
1085 }
1086 case Instruction::BitCast:
Dan Gohman6cc18fe2009-07-01 21:38:46 +00001087 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isIntOrIntVector())
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001088 return false; // vector->int or fp->int?
Dan Gohman6cc18fe2009-07-01 21:38:46 +00001089
1090 if (const VectorType *DstVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getType())) {
1091 if (const VectorType *SrcVTy =
1092 dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
1093 if (DstVTy->getNumElements() != SrcVTy->getNumElements())
1094 // Don't touch a bitcast between vectors of different element counts.
1095 return false;
1096 } else
1097 // Don't touch a scalar-to-vector bitcast.
1098 return false;
1099 } else if (isa<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType()))
1100 // Don't touch a vector-to-scalar bitcast.
1101 return false;
1102
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001103 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001104 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001105 return I;
1106 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001107 break;
1108 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1109 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001110 unsigned SrcBitWidth =I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001111
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001112 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1113 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1114 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001115 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001116 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001117 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001118 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1119 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1120 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001121 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001122 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001123 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001124 break;
1125 }
1126 case Instruction::SExt: {
1127 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001128 unsigned SrcBitWidth =I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001129
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001130 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001131 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001132
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001133 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001134 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1135 // bit is demanded.
1136 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001137 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001138
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001139 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1140 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1141 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001142 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), InputDemandedBits,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001143 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001144 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001145 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1146 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1147 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001148 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001149
1150 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1151 // top bits of the result.
1152
1153 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1154 // convert this into a zero extension.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001155 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001156 // Convert to ZExt cast
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001157 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName());
1158 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *I);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001159 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001160 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001161 }
1162 break;
1163 }
1164 case Instruction::Add: {
1165 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1166 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1167 // either.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001168 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001169
1170 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1171 // we can do.
1172 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1173 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1174 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1175 if (RHS->isZero())
1176 break;
1177
1178 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1179 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001180 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001181
1182 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001183 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), InDemandedBits,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001184 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001185 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001186
1187 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1188 // the constant.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001189 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001190 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001191
1192 // Avoid excess work.
1193 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1194 break;
1195
1196 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1197 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1198 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001199 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001200 I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001201 return InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001202 }
1203
1204 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1205 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1206 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1207 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1208 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1209
1210 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1211 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1212 // this scan.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001213 const APInt &RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001214 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001215
1216 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1217
1218 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1219 // other, and there is no input carry.
1220 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1221 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1222
1223 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1224 // is no input carry.
1225 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1226 } else {
1227 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1228 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001229 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001230 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1231 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001232 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001233 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedFromOps,
1234 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1235 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedFromOps,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001236 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001237 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001238 }
1239 }
1240 break;
1241 }
1242 case Instruction::Sub:
1243 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1244 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001245 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001246 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1247 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001248 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001249 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001250 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedFromOps,
1251 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1252 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedFromOps,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001253 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001254 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001255 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001256 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1257 // the known zeros and ones.
1258 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001259 break;
1260 case Instruction::Shl:
1261 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001262 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001263 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001264 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001265 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001266 return I;
1267 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001268 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1269 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1270 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001271 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001272 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001273 }
1274 break;
1275 case Instruction::LShr:
1276 // For a logical shift right
1277 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001278 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001279
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001280 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001281 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001282 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001283 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001284 return I;
1285 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001286 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1287 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001288 if (ShiftAmt) {
1289 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001290 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001291 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1292 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001293 }
1294 break;
1295 case Instruction::AShr:
1296 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1297 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1298 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1299 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1300 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1301 // Perform the logical shift right.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001302 Instruction *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001303 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001304 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001305 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001306
1307 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1308 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1309 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001310 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001311
1312 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001313 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001314
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001315 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001316 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001317 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1318 // demanded.
1319 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1320 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001321 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001322 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001323 return I;
1324 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001325 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001326 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001327 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1328 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1329
1330 // Handle the sign bits.
1331 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1332 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1333 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1334
1335 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1336 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001337 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001338 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1339 // Perform the logical shift right.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001340 Instruction *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001341 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001342 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001343 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1344 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1345 }
1346 }
1347 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001348 case Instruction::SRem:
1349 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001350 APInt RA = Rem->getValue().abs();
1351 if (RA.isPowerOf2()) {
Eli Friedmana999a512009-06-17 02:57:36 +00001352 if (DemandedMask.ult(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001353 return I->getOperand(0);
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001354
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001355 APInt LowBits = RA - 1;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001356 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001357 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), Mask2,
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001358 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001359 return I;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001360
1361 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1362 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001363
1364 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001365
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001366 assert(!(KnownZero & KnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001367 }
1368 }
1369 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001370 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001371 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1372 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001373 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), AllOnes,
1374 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1) ||
1375 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001376 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001377 return I;
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001378
Chris Lattner455e9ab2009-01-21 18:09:24 +00001379 unsigned Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001380 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1381 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1382 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001383 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001384 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001385 case Instruction::Call:
1386 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1387 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1388 default: break;
1389 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1390 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1391 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1392 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1393 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1394
1395 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1396 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1397 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1398 NLZ &= ~7;
1399 NTZ &= ~7;
1400 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1401 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1402 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1403 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1404
1405 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1406 // the right place.
1407 Instruction *NewVal;
1408 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1409 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00001410 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001411 else
1412 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00001413 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001414 NewVal->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001415 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001416 }
1417
1418 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1419 break;
1420 }
1421 }
1422 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001423 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001424 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001425 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001426
1427 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1428 // constant.
Dan Gohman43ee5f72009-08-03 22:07:33 +00001429 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1430 return Constant::getIntegerValue(VTy, RHSKnownOne);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001431 return false;
1432}
1433
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001434
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001435/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value produces a vector with
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001436/// any number of elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001437/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1438/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1439///
1440/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1441/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1442/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001443Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, APInt DemandedElts,
1444 APInt& UndefElts,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001445 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001446 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001447 APInt EltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001448 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001449
1450 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1451 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1452 UndefElts = EltMask;
1453 return 0;
1454 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1455 UndefElts = EltMask;
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001456 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001457 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001458
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001459 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001460 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1461 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001462 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001463
1464 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1465 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001466 if (!DemandedElts[i]) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001467 Elts.push_back(Undef);
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001468 UndefElts.set(i);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001469 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1470 Elts.push_back(Undef);
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001471 UndefElts.set(i);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001472 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1473 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1474 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001475
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001476 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00001477 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001478 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1479 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001480 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001481 // set to undef.
Mon P Wange0b436a2008-11-06 22:52:21 +00001482
1483 // Check if this is identity. If so, return 0 since we are not simplifying
1484 // anything.
1485 if (DemandedElts == ((1ULL << VWidth) -1))
1486 return 0;
1487
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001488 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00001489 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001490 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001491 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001492 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i) {
1493 Constant *Elt = DemandedElts[i] ? Zero : Undef;
1494 Elts.push_back(Elt);
1495 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001496 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00001497 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001498 }
1499
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001500 // Limit search depth.
1501 if (Depth == 10)
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001502 return 0;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001503
1504 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1505 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1506 // are needed.
1507 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1508 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1509 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1510 // the main instcombine process.
1511 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001512 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001513 return 0;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001514
1515 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1516 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001517 }
1518
1519 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001520 if (!I) return 0; // Only analyze instructions.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001521
1522 bool MadeChange = false;
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001523 APInt UndefElts2(VWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001524 Value *TmpV;
1525 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1526 default: break;
1527
1528 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1529 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1530 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001531 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001532 if (Idx == 0) {
1533 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1534 // which elt is getting updated.
1535 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1536 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1537 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1538 break;
1539 }
1540
1541 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1542 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001543 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerc3a3e362009-08-30 06:20:05 +00001544 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || !DemandedElts[IdxNo]) {
1545 Worklist.Add(I);
1546 return I->getOperand(0);
1547 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001548
1549 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1550 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001551 APInt DemandedElts2 = DemandedElts;
1552 DemandedElts2.clear(IdxNo);
1553 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts2,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001554 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1555 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1556
1557 // The inserted element is defined.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001558 UndefElts.clear(IdxNo);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001559 break;
1560 }
1561 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1562 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001563 uint64_t LHSVWidth =
1564 cast<VectorType>(Shuffle->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001565 APInt LeftDemanded(LHSVWidth, 0), RightDemanded(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001566 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001567 if (DemandedElts[i]) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001568 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1569 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001570 assert(MaskVal < LHSVWidth * 2 &&
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001571 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001572 if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001573 LeftDemanded.set(MaskVal);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001574 else
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001575 RightDemanded.set(MaskVal - LHSVWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001576 }
1577 }
1578 }
1579
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001580 APInt UndefElts4(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001581 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001582 UndefElts4, Depth+1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001583 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1584
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001585 APInt UndefElts3(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001586 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1587 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1588 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1589
1590 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1591 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1592 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohmancb893092008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001593 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001594 UndefElts.set(i);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001595 } else if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth) {
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001596 if (UndefElts4[MaskVal]) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001597 NewUndefElts = true;
1598 UndefElts.set(i);
1599 }
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001600 } else {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001601 if (UndefElts3[MaskVal - LHSVWidth]) {
1602 NewUndefElts = true;
1603 UndefElts.set(i);
1604 }
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001605 }
1606 }
1607
1608 if (NewUndefElts) {
1609 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1610 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1611 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001612 if (UndefElts[i])
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001613 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001614 else
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001615 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context),
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001616 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1617 }
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00001618 I->setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001619 MadeChange = true;
1620 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001621 break;
1622 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001623 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001624 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001625 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1626 if (!VTy) break;
1627 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001628 APInt InputDemandedElts(InVWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001629 unsigned Ratio;
1630
1631 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001632 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001633 // elements as are demanded of us.
1634 Ratio = 1;
1635 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1636 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1637 // Untested so far.
1638 break;
1639
1640 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1641 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1642 // elements are live.
1643 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1644 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001645 if (DemandedElts[OutIdx])
1646 InputDemandedElts.set(OutIdx/Ratio);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001647 }
1648 } else {
1649 // Untested so far.
1650 break;
1651
1652 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1653 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1654 // live.
1655 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1656 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001657 if (DemandedElts[InIdx/Ratio])
1658 InputDemandedElts.set(InIdx);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001659 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001660
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001661 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1662 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1663 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1664 if (TmpV) {
1665 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1666 MadeChange = true;
1667 }
1668
1669 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1670 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001671 llvm_unreachable("Unimp");
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001672 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1673 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1674 // undef.
1675 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001676 if (UndefElts2[OutIdx/Ratio])
1677 UndefElts.set(OutIdx);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001678 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001679 llvm_unreachable("Unimp");
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001680 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1681 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1682 // elements are undef.
1683 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1684 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001685 if (!UndefElts2[InIdx]) // Not undef?
1686 UndefElts.clear(InIdx/Ratio); // Clear undef bit.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001687 }
1688 break;
1689 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001690 case Instruction::And:
1691 case Instruction::Or:
1692 case Instruction::Xor:
1693 case Instruction::Add:
1694 case Instruction::Sub:
1695 case Instruction::Mul:
1696 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1697 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1698 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1699 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1700 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1701 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1702 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1703
1704 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1705 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1706 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1707 break;
1708
1709 case Instruction::Call: {
1710 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1711 if (!II) break;
1712 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1713 default: break;
1714
1715 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1716 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1717 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1718 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1719 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1720 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1721 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1722 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1723 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1724 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1725 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1726 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1727 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1728 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1729 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1730 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1731
1732 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1733 // scalarize it now.
1734 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1735 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1736 default: break;
1737 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1738 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1739 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1740 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1741 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1742 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1743 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1744 // Extract the element as scalars.
Eric Christophera3500da2009-07-25 02:28:41 +00001745 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(ExtractElementInst::Create(LHS,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001746 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0U, false), "tmp"), *II);
Eric Christophera3500da2009-07-25 02:28:41 +00001747 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(ExtractElementInst::Create(RHS,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001748 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0U, false), "tmp"), *II);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001749
1750 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001751 default: llvm_unreachable("Case stmts out of sync!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001752 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1753 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00001754 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001755 II->getName()), *II);
1756 break;
1757 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1758 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00001759 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateFMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001760 II->getName()), *II);
1761 break;
1762 }
1763
1764 Instruction *New =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001765 InsertElementInst::Create(
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001766 UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001767 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0U, false), II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001768 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001769 return New;
1770 }
1771 }
1772
1773 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1774 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1775 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1776 break;
1777 }
1778 break;
1779 }
1780 }
1781 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1782}
1783
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001784
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001785/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1786/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1787/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1788/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1789/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1790/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1791/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1792///
1793template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001794static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001795 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1796 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1797
1798 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1799 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1800 return F.apply(Root);
1801
1802 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1803 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001804 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001805 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1806 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1807
1808 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1809 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1810 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1811 ShouldApply = true;
1812 }
1813
1814 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1815 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1816 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001817 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1818 // and perform the reassociation.
1819 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1820
1821 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1822 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1823
1824 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1825 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001826 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00001827 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001828 return 0;
1829 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001830 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001831 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001832 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001833 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001834 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001835
1836 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1837 // get to LHSI.
1838 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1839 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001840 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1841 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001842 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001843 ARI = NextLHSI;
1844
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001845 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1846 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1847 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1848 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1849 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001850
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001851 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1852 // the transformation...
1853 return F.apply(Root);
1854 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001855
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001856 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1857 }
1858 return 0;
1859}
1860
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001861namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001862
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001863// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001864struct AddRHS {
1865 Value *RHS;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00001866 explicit AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001867 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1868 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001869 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00001870 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001871 }
1872};
1873
1874// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1875// iff C1&C2 == 0
1876struct AddMaskingAnd {
1877 Constant *C2;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00001878 explicit AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001879 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001880 ConstantInt *C1;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00001881 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00001882 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001883 }
1884 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001885 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001886 }
1887};
1888
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001889}
1890
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001891static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001892 InstCombiner *IC) {
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00001893 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I))
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00001894 return IC->Builder->CreateCast(CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType());
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001895
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001896 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001897 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1898 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001899
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001900 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1901 if (ConstIsRHS)
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00001902 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1903 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001904 }
1905
1906 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1907 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1908 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00001909
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001910 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00001911 return IC->Builder->CreateBinOp(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,
1912 SO->getName()+".op");
1913 if (ICmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(&I))
1914 return IC->Builder->CreateICmp(CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1915 SO->getName()+".cmp");
1916 if (FCmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(&I))
1917 return IC->Builder->CreateICmp(CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1918 SO->getName()+".cmp");
1919 llvm_unreachable("Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001920}
1921
1922// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1923// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1924// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1925// not have a second operand.
1926static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1927 InstCombiner *IC) {
1928 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1929 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1930 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1931 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1932
1933 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001934 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001935 if (SI->getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*IC->getContext())) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001936
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001937 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1938 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1939
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001940 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1941 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001942 }
1943 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001944}
1945
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001946
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00001947/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator, cast instruction, or select which
1948/// has a PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the
1949/// PHI (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00001950///
1951/// If AllowAggressive is true, FoldOpIntoPhi will allow certain transforms
1952/// that would normally be unprofitable because they strongly encourage jump
1953/// threading.
1954Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I,
1955 bool AllowAggressive) {
1956 AllowAggressive = false;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001957 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001958 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00001959 if (NumPHIValues == 0 ||
1960 // We normally only transform phis with a single use, unless we're trying
1961 // hard to make jump threading happen.
1962 (!PN->hasOneUse() && !AllowAggressive))
1963 return 0;
1964
1965
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00001966 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are simple constants
1967 // (constantint/constantfp/undef). If there is one non-constant value,
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00001968 // remember the BB it is in. If there is more than one or if *it* is a PHI,
1969 // bail out. We don't do arbitrary constant expressions here because moving
1970 // their computation can be expensive without a cost model.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001971 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1972 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00001973 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i)) ||
1974 isa<ConstantExpr>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001975 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001976 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001977 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1978
1979 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1980 // loop.
1981 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1982 return 0;
1983 }
1984
1985 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1986 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1987 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1988 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00001989 if (NonConstBB != 0 && !AllowAggressive) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001990 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1991 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1992 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001993
1994 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001995 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001996 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001997 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001998 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001999
2000 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002001 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(&I)) {
2002 // We only currently try to fold the condition of a select when it is a phi,
2003 // not the true/false values.
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002004 Value *TrueV = SI->getTrueValue();
2005 Value *FalseV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner3ddfb212009-09-28 06:49:44 +00002006 BasicBlock *PhiTransBB = PN->getParent();
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002007 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002008 BasicBlock *ThisBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
Chris Lattner3ddfb212009-09-28 06:49:44 +00002009 Value *TrueVInPred = TrueV->DoPHITranslation(PhiTransBB, ThisBB);
2010 Value *FalseVInPred = FalseV->DoPHITranslation(PhiTransBB, ThisBB);
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002011 Value *InV = 0;
2012 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002013 InV = InC->isNullValue() ? FalseVInPred : TrueVInPred;
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002014 } else {
2015 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002016 InV = SelectInst::Create(PN->getIncomingValue(i), TrueVInPred,
2017 FalseVInPred,
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002018 "phitmp", NonConstBB->getTerminator());
2019 Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
2020 }
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002021 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, ThisBB);
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002022 }
2023 } else if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002024 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00002025 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00002026 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002027 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002028 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002029 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002030 else
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002031 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002032 } else {
2033 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
2034 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002035 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002036 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
2037 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002038 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00002039 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002040 CI->getPredicate(),
2041 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
2042 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002043 else
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00002044 llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!");
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002045
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00002046 Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002047 }
2048 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002049 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002050 } else {
2051 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
2052 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00002053 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002054 Value *InV;
2055 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002056 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002057 } else {
2058 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002059 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002060 I.getType(), "phitmp",
2061 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00002062 Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002063 }
2064 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002065 }
2066 }
2067 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
2068}
2069
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002070
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002071/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
2072/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
2073/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
2074/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
2075bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2076 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
2077 // ones.
2078
2079 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
2080 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
2081 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
2082 // sign extend fine.
2083 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
2084 return true;
2085
2086
2087 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
2088 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
2089 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
2090 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
2091
2092 // TODO: Implement.
2093
2094 return false;
2095}
2096
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002097
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002098Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002099 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002100 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002101
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002102 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002103 // X + undef -> undef
2104 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
2105 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
2106
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002107 // X + 0 --> X
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002108 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
2109 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002110
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002111 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002112 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002113 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002114 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002115 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002116 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002117
2118 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
2119 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002120 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00002121 return &I;
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002122
Eli Friedman709b33d2009-07-13 22:27:52 +00002123 // zext(bool) + C -> bool ? C + 1 : C
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002124 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(LHS))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002125 if (ZI->getSrcTy() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002126 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0), AddOne(CI), CI);
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002127 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002128
2129 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2130 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2131 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002132
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002133 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2134 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002135 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002136 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002137 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002138 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002139
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002140 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002141 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2142 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002143 do {
2144 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002145 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2146 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002147 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2148 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002149 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002150 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2151 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002152 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002153 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002154 }
2155 }
2156 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002157 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2158 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2159 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002160
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002161 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002162 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2163 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2164 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002165 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2166 switch (Size) {
2167 default: break;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002168 case 32: MiddleType = Type::getInt32Ty(*Context); break;
2169 case 16: MiddleType = Type::getInt16Ty(*Context); break;
2170 case 8: MiddleType = Type::getInt8Ty(*Context); break;
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002171 }
2172 if (MiddleType) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002173 Value *NewTrunc = Builder->CreateTrunc(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002174 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002175 }
2176 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002177 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002178
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002179 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002180 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2181
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002182 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002183 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002184 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002185 return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002186
2187 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2188 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2189 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2190 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2191 }
2192 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2193 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2194 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2195 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2196 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002197 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002198
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002199 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002200 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002201 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002202 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002203 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002204 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002205 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002206 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002207 }
2208
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002209 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002210 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002211
2212 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002213 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002214 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002215 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002216
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002217
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002218 ConstantInt *C2;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002219 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002220 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002221 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002222
2223 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2224 ConstantInt *C1;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002225 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002226 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, ConstantExpr::getAdd(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002227 }
2228
2229 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002230 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
2231 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002232
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002233 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002234 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS ||
2235 dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002236 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002237
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002238
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002239 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002240 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
2241 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002242 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002243
2244 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2245 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2246 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2247 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2248 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2249 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2250 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2251 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2252 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2253 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2254
2255 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002256 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002257 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002258 }
2259 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002260
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002261 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002262 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002263 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002264 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2265 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002266 if (W != Y) {
2267 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002268 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002269 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002270 std::swap(W, X);
2271 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002272 std::swap(Y, Z);
2273 std::swap(W, X);
2274 }
2275 }
2276
2277 if (W == Y) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002278 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(X, Z, LHS->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002279 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002280 }
2281 }
2282 }
2283
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002284 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002285 Value *X = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002286 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002287 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002288
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002289 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002290 if (LHS->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002291 match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002292 Constant *Anded = ConstantExpr::getAnd(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002293 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2294 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2295 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002296 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002297
2298 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002299 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002300
2301 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002302 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002303
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002304 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2305 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002306 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(X, CRHS, LHS->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002307 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002308 }
2309 }
2310 }
2311
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002312 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2313 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002314 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002315 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002316 }
2317
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002318 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002319 {
2320 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002321 Value *A = RHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002322 if (!SI) {
2323 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002324 A = LHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002325 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002326 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002327 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2328 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002329 Value *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002330
2331 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2332 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002333 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) &&
2334 match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002335 // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002336 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002337 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) &&
2338 match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002339 // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002340 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002341 }
2342 }
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002343
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002344 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2345 // integer add followed by a sext.
2346 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2347 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2348 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2349 Constant *CI =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002350 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002351 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002352 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002353 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2354 // Insert the new, smaller add.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002355 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2356 CI, "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002357 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2358 }
2359 }
2360
2361 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2362 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2363 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2364 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2365 // integer add will not overflow.
2366 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2367 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2368 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2369 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2370 // Insert the new integer add.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002371 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2372 RHSConv->getOperand(0), "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002373 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2374 }
2375 }
2376 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002377
2378 return Changed ? &I : 0;
2379}
2380
2381Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
2382 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
2383 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
2384
2385 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
2386 // X + 0 --> X
2387 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Owen Anderson6f83c9c2009-07-27 20:59:43 +00002388 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002389 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
2390 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2391 }
2392
2393 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2394 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2395 return NV;
2396 }
2397
2398 // -A + B --> B - A
2399 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002400 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castFNegVal(LHS))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002401 return BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(RHS, LHSV);
2402
2403 // A + -B --> A - B
2404 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002405 if (Value *V = dyn_castFNegVal(RHS))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002406 return BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(LHS, V);
2407
2408 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2409 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2410 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2411 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2412
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002413 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2414 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2415 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2416 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2417 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2418 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2419 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2420 // instcombined.
2421 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2422 Constant *CI =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002423 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002424 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002425 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002426 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2427 // Insert the new integer add.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002428 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2429 CI, "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002430 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2431 }
2432 }
2433
2434 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2435 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2436 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2437 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2438 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2439 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2440 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2441 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2442 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2443 // Insert the new integer add.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002444 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2445 RHSConv->getOperand(0), "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002446 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2447 }
2448 }
2449 }
2450
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002451 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002452}
2453
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002454Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002455 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002456
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002457 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002458 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002459
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002460 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002461 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002462 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002463
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002464 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2465 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2466 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2467 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2468
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002469 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2470 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002471 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002472 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002473
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002474 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002475 Value *X = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002476 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002477 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002478
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002479 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2480 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002481 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002482 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002483 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002484 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002485 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002486 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002487 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002488 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002489 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002490 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002491 }
2492 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002493 }
2494 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2495 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2496 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002497 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002498 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002499 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002500 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002501 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002502 }
2503 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002504 }
2505 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002506 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002507
2508 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2509 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002510 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002511 return R;
Eli Friedman709b33d2009-07-13 22:27:52 +00002512
2513 // C - zext(bool) -> bool ? C - 1 : C
2514 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op1))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002515 if (ZI->getSrcTy() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002516 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0), SubOne(C), C);
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002517 }
2518
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002519 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002520 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2521
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002522 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002523 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002524 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002525 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002526 I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002527 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002528 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002529 I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002530 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2531 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2532 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002533 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002534 ConstantExpr::getSub(CI1, CI2), Op1I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002535 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002536 }
2537
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002538 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002539 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2540 // is not used by anyone else...
2541 //
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002542 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002543 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2544 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2545 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2546 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002547
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002548 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002549 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002550 }
2551
2552 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2553 //
2554 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2555 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2556 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2557
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002558 Value *NewNot = Builder->CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002559 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002560 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002561
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002562 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002563 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002564 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002565 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002566 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002567 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002568 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002569
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002570 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002571 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002572 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002573 Constant *CP1 =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002574 ConstantExpr::getSub(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002575 C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002576 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002577 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002578 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002579 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002580
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002581 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
2582 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
2583 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2584 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2585 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2586 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
2587 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2588 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002589 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002590 I.getName());
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002591 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002592 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002593
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002594 ConstantInt *C1;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002595 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002596 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002597 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002598
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002599 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002600 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002601 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, ConstantExpr::getSub(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002602 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002603 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002604}
2605
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002606Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
2607 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2608
2609 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002610 if (Value *V = dyn_castFNegVal(Op1))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002611 return BinaryOperator::CreateFAdd(Op0, V);
2612
2613 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2614 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd) {
2615 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002616 return BinaryOperator::CreateFNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002617 I.getName());
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002618 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002619 return BinaryOperator::CreateFNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002620 I.getName());
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002621 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002622 }
2623
2624 return 0;
2625}
2626
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002627/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2628/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2629/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2630/// signed.
2631static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2632 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002633 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002634 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2635 TrueIfSigned = true;
2636 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002637 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2638 TrueIfSigned = true;
2639 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002640 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2641 TrueIfSigned = false;
2642 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002643 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2644 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2645 TrueIfSigned = true;
2646 return RHS->getValue() ==
2647 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2648 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2649 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2650 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002651 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002652 default:
2653 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002654 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002655}
2656
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002657Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002658 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002659 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002660
Eli Friedman1694e092009-07-18 09:12:15 +00002661 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002662 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002663
Chris Lattner8af304a2009-10-11 07:53:15 +00002664 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS.
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002665 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2666 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002667
2668 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002669 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002670 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2671 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002672 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002673 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002674
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002675 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002676 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2677 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2679 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002680 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002681
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002682 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002683 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002684 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00002685 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002686 }
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002687 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
Eli Friedmanb4687092009-07-14 02:01:53 +00002688 if (Op1->isNullValue())
2689 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002690
2691 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
2692 if (Op1V->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002693 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002694
2695 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2696 if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002697 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Splat))
2698 if (CI->equalsInt(1))
2699 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2700 }
2701 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002702 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002703
2704 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2705 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002706 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002707 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002708 Value *Add = Builder->CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op1, "tmp");
2709 Value *C1C2 = Builder->CreateMul(Op1, Op0I->getOperand(1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002710 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002711
2712 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002713
2714 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2715 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002716 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002717 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002718
2719 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2720 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2721 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002722 }
2723
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002724 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2725 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002726 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002727
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002728 // (X / Y) * Y = X - (X % Y)
2729 // (X / Y) * -Y = (X % Y) - X
2730 {
2731 Value *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2732 BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
2733 if (!BO ||
2734 (BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::UDiv &&
2735 BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::SDiv)) {
2736 Op1 = Op0;
2737 BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1));
2738 }
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002739 Value *Neg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002740 if (BO && BO->hasOneUse() &&
2741 (BO->getOperand(1) == Op1 || BO->getOperand(1) == Neg) &&
2742 (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv ||
2743 BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)) {
2744 Value *Op0BO = BO->getOperand(0), *Op1BO = BO->getOperand(1);
2745
Dan Gohmanfa94b942009-08-12 16:33:09 +00002746 // If the division is exact, X % Y is zero.
2747 if (SDivOperator *SDiv = dyn_cast<SDivOperator>(BO))
2748 if (SDiv->isExact()) {
2749 if (Op1BO == Op1)
2750 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0BO);
2751 else
2752 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0BO);
2753 }
2754
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002755 Value *Rem;
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002756 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002757 Rem = Builder->CreateURem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002758 else
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002759 Rem = Builder->CreateSRem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002760 Rem->takeName(BO);
2761
2762 if (Op1BO == Op1)
2763 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Op0BO, Rem);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002764 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Rem, Op0BO);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002765 }
2766 }
2767
Chris Lattner8af304a2009-10-11 07:53:15 +00002768 /// i1 mul -> i1 and.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002769 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002770 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2771
Chris Lattner8af304a2009-10-11 07:53:15 +00002772 // X*(1 << Y) --> X << Y
2773 // (1 << Y)*X --> X << Y
2774 {
2775 Value *Y;
2776 if (match(Op0, m_Shl(m_One(), m_Value(Y))))
2777 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I.getOperand(1), Y);
2778 if (match(I.getOperand(1), m_Shl(m_One(), m_Value(Y))))
2779 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0, Y);
2780 }
2781
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002782 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2783 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
Chris Lattnerd2c58362009-10-11 21:29:45 +00002784 // X * Y (where Y is 0 or 1) -> X & (0-Y)
2785 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2786 // -2 is "-1 << 1" so it is all bits set except the low one.
2787 APInt Negative2(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), -2, true);
Chris Lattner0036e3a2009-10-11 21:22:21 +00002788
Chris Lattnerd2c58362009-10-11 21:29:45 +00002789 Value *BoolCast = 0, *OtherOp = 0;
2790 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Negative2))
2791 BoolCast = Op0, OtherOp = I.getOperand(1);
2792 else if (MaskedValueIsZero(I.getOperand(1), Negative2))
2793 BoolCast = I.getOperand(1), OtherOp = Op0;
2794
Chris Lattner0036e3a2009-10-11 21:22:21 +00002795 if (BoolCast) {
Chris Lattner0036e3a2009-10-11 21:22:21 +00002796 Value *V = Builder->CreateSub(Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
2797 BoolCast, "tmp");
2798 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002799 }
2800 }
2801
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002802 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002803}
2804
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002805Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
2806 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
2807 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
2808
2809 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
2810 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2811 if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
2812 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2813 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
2814 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2815 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2816 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2817 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
2818 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2819 if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
2820 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Splat))
2821 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2822 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2823 }
2824 }
2825 }
2826
2827 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2828 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2829 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2830 return R;
2831
2832 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2833 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2834 return NV;
2835 }
2836
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002837 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castFNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2838 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castFNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002839 return BinaryOperator::CreateFMul(Op0v, Op1v);
2840
2841 return Changed ? &I : 0;
2842}
2843
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002844/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2845/// instruction.
2846bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2847 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2848
2849 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2850 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2851 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2852 if (ST->isNullValue())
2853 NonNullOperand = 2;
2854 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2855 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2856 if (ST->isNullValue())
2857 NonNullOperand = 1;
2858
2859 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2860 return false;
2861
2862 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2863
2864 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2865 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2866
2867 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2868 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2869 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2870 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2871 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2872
2873 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2874 // early exit.
2875 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2876 return true;
2877
2878 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2879 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2880
2881 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2882 --BBI;
2883 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2884 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2885 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2886 break;
2887
2888 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2889 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2890 I != E; ++I) {
2891 if (*I == SI) {
2892 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00002893 Worklist.Add(BBI);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002894 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00002895 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context) :
2896 ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00002897 Worklist.Add(BBI);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002898 }
2899 }
2900
2901 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2902 if (&*BBI == SI)
2903 SI = 0;
2904 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2905 SelectCond = 0;
2906
2907 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2908 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2909 break;
2910
2911 }
2912 return true;
2913}
2914
2915
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002916/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2917/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2918/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2919/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002920Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002921 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002922
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002923 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2924 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2925 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2926 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2927 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002928 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002929 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002930
2931 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002932 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002933 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002934
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002935 return 0;
2936}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002937
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002938/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2939/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2940/// division instructions.
2941/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002942Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002943 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2944
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002945 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002946 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2947 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00002948 Constant *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002949 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00002950 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002951 }
2952
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00002953 Constant *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002954 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2955 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002956
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002957 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2958 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002959
2960 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2961 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2962 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2963 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002964
2965 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2966 // div X, 1 == X
2967 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2968 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2969
2970 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2971 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2972 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2973 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002974 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002975 I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002976 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002977 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002978 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002979 ConstantExpr::getMul(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002980 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002981
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002982 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002983 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2984 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2985 return R;
2986 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2987 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2988 return NV;
2989 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002990 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002991
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002992 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002993 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002994 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002995 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002996
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002997 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002998 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002999 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3000
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00003001 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3002 if (ConstantInt *X = cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
3003 // div X, 1 == X
3004 if (X->isOne())
3005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3006 }
3007
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003008 return 0;
3009}
3010
3011Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3012 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3013
3014 // Handle the integer div common cases
3015 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
3016 return Common;
3017
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003018 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003019 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
3020 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
3021 // if so, convert to a right shift.
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003022 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003023 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003024 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003025
3026 // X udiv C, where C >= signbit
3027 if (C->getValue().isNegative()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003028 Value *IC = Builder->CreateICmpULT( Op0, C);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003029 return SelectInst::Create(IC, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003030 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003031 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003032 }
3033
3034 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003035 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003036 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3037 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003038 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003039 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003040 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003041 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003042 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2())
3043 N = Builder->CreateAdd(N, ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2), "tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003044 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003045 }
3046 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00003047 }
3048
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003049 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
3050 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003051 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003052 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003053 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003054 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003055 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003056 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003057 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003058 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003059 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003060 Value *TSI = Builder->CreateLShr(Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003061
3062 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003063 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003064 Value *FSI = Builder->CreateLShr(Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003065
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003066 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003067 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003068 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003069 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003070 return 0;
3071}
3072
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003073Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3074 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3075
3076 // Handle the integer div common cases
3077 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
3078 return Common;
3079
3080 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3081 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
3082 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003083 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Dan Gohman1bdf5dc2009-08-11 20:47:47 +00003084
Dan Gohmanfa94b942009-08-12 16:33:09 +00003085 // sdiv X, C --> ashr X, log2(C)
Dan Gohman1bdf5dc2009-08-11 20:47:47 +00003086 if (cast<SDivOperator>(&I)->isExact() &&
3087 RHS->getValue().isNonNegative() &&
3088 RHS->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3089 Value *ShAmt = llvm::ConstantInt::get(RHS->getType(),
3090 RHS->getValue().exactLogBase2());
3091 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(Op0, ShAmt, I.getName());
3092 }
Dan Gohman9ca9daa2009-08-12 16:37:02 +00003093
3094 // -X/C --> X/-C provided the negation doesn't overflow.
3095 if (SubOperator *Sub = dyn_cast<SubOperator>(Op0))
3096 if (isa<Constant>(Sub->getOperand(0)) &&
3097 cast<Constant>(Sub->getOperand(0))->isNullValue() &&
Dan Gohman5078f842009-08-20 17:11:38 +00003098 Sub->hasNoSignedWrap())
Dan Gohman9ca9daa2009-08-12 16:37:02 +00003099 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Sub->getOperand(1),
3100 ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003101 }
3102
3103 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
3104 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003105 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003106 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Eli Friedman8be17392009-07-18 09:53:21 +00003107 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3108 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask)) {
3109 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
3110 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
3111 }
3112 ConstantInt *ShiftedInt;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003113 if (match(Op1, m_Shl(m_ConstantInt(ShiftedInt), m_Value())) &&
Eli Friedman8be17392009-07-18 09:53:21 +00003114 ShiftedInt->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3115 // X sdiv (1 << Y) -> X udiv (1 << Y) ( -> X u>> Y)
3116 // Safe because the only negative value (1 << Y) can take on is
3117 // INT_MIN, and X sdiv INT_MIN == X udiv INT_MIN == 0 if X doesn't have
3118 // the sign bit set.
3119 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
3120 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003121 }
Eli Friedman8be17392009-07-18 09:53:21 +00003122 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003123
3124 return 0;
3125}
3126
3127Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3128 return commonDivTransforms(I);
3129}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003130
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003131/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
3132/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
3133/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
3134/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
3135Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003136 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003137
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00003138 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
3139 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
3140 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003141 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00003142 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003143 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
3144 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003145
3146 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00003147 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
3148 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00003149
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003150 return 0;
3151}
3152
3153/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
3154/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
3155/// remainder instructions.
3156/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
3157Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
3158 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3159
3160 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
3161 return common;
3162
Dale Johannesened6af242009-01-21 00:35:19 +00003163 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
3164 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
3165 if (LHS->isNullValue())
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003166 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Dale Johannesened6af242009-01-21 00:35:19 +00003167
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003168 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003169 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
3170 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00003171 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003172
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003173 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003174 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003175
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003176 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
3177 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
3178 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
3179 return R;
3180 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
3181 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3182 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003183 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00003184
3185 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00003186 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00003187 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003188 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003189 }
3190
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003191 return 0;
3192}
3193
3194Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3195 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3196
3197 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3198 return common;
3199
3200 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3201 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
3202 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
3203 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
3204 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003205 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003206 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003207 }
3208
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003209 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003210 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
3211 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3212 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00003213 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003214 Constant *N1 = Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003215 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(RHSI, N1, "tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003216 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003217 }
3218 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003219 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003220
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003221 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3222 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3223 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3224 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3225 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3226 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003227 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3228 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003229 Value *TrueAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO),
3230 SI->getName()+".t");
3231 Value *FalseAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO),
3232 SI->getName()+".f");
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003233 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003234 }
3235 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003236 }
3237
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003238 return 0;
3239}
3240
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003241Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3242 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3243
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003244 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +00003245 if (Instruction *Common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3246 return Common;
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003247
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003248 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003249 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3250 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3251 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003252 // X % -Y -> X % Y
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +00003253 Worklist.AddValue(I.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003254 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3255 return &I;
3256 }
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003257
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003258 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003259 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003260 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3261 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3262 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3263 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003264 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003265 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003266 }
3267
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003268 // If it's a constant vector, flip any negative values positive.
Nick Lewycky9dce8732008-12-20 16:48:00 +00003269 if (ConstantVector *RHSV = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3270 unsigned VWidth = RHSV->getNumOperands();
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003271
Nick Lewycky9dce8732008-12-20 16:48:00 +00003272 bool hasNegative = false;
3273 for (unsigned i = 0; !hasNegative && i != VWidth; ++i)
3274 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i)))
3275 if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
3276 hasNegative = true;
3277
3278 if (hasNegative) {
3279 std::vector<Constant *> Elts(VWidth);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003280 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i) {
3281 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i))) {
3282 if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003283 Elts[i] = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003284 else
3285 Elts[i] = RHS;
3286 }
3287 }
3288
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00003289 Constant *NewRHSV = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003290 if (NewRHSV != RHSV) {
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +00003291 Worklist.AddValue(I.getOperand(1));
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003292 I.setOperand(1, NewRHSV);
3293 return &I;
3294 }
3295 }
3296 }
3297
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003298 return 0;
3299}
3300
3301Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003302 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3303}
3304
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003305// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3306// constant.
3307static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003308 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003309}
3310
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003311// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3312// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3313static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003314 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003315}
3316
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003317/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003318/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3319///
3320/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3321///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003322/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3323/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003324///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003325/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3326/// 0 A > B
3327/// 1 A == B
3328/// 2 A < B
3329///
3330/// <=> Value Definition
3331/// 000 0 Always false
3332/// 001 1 A > B
3333/// 010 2 A == B
3334/// 011 3 A >= B
3335/// 100 4 A < B
3336/// 101 5 A != B
3337/// 110 6 A <= B
3338/// 111 7 Always true
3339///
3340static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3341 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003342 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003343 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3344 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3345 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3346 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3347 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3348 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3349 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3350 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3351 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3352 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003353 // True -> 7
3354 default:
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003355 llvm_unreachable("Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003356 return 0;
3357 }
3358}
3359
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003360/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
3361/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
3362/// predicate by reference.
3363static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
3364 isOrdered = false;
3365 switch (CC) {
3366 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
3367 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003368 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
3369 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3370 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
3371 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003372 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
3373 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3374 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
3375 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003376 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
3377 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003378 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
3379 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003380 // True -> 7
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003381 default:
3382 // Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003383 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003384 return 0;
3385 }
3386}
3387
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003388/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3389/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003390/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003391/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003392static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00003393 LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003394 switch (code) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003395 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal ICmp code!");
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003396 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003397 case 1:
3398 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003399 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003400 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003401 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3402 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003403 case 3:
3404 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003405 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003406 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003407 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003408 case 4:
3409 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003410 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003411 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003412 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3413 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003414 case 6:
3415 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003416 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003417 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003418 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003419 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003420 }
3421}
3422
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003423/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
3424/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
3425/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
3426static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00003427 Value *LHS, Value *RHS, LLVMContext *Context) {
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003428 switch (code) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003429 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal FCmp code!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003430 case 0:
3431 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003432 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003433 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003434 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003435 case 1:
3436 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003437 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003438 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003439 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003440 case 2:
3441 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003442 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003443 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003444 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003445 case 3:
3446 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003447 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003448 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003449 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003450 case 4:
3451 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003452 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003453 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003454 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003455 case 5:
3456 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003457 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003458 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003459 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003460 case 6:
3461 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003462 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003463 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003464 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003465 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003466 }
3467}
3468
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003469/// PredicatesFoldable - Return true if both predicates match sign or if at
3470/// least one of them is an equality comparison (which is signless).
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003471static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3472 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003473 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p2)) ||
3474 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003475}
3476
3477namespace {
3478// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3479struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003480 InstCombiner &IC;
3481 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003482 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3483 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3484 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3485 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003486 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003487 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3488 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003489 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3490 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003491 return false;
3492 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003493 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3494 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3495 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3496 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3497 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003498 }
3499
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003500 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003501 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003502 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003503 unsigned Code;
3504 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3505 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3506 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3507 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003508 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003509 }
3510
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003511 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3512 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3513
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003514 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS, IC.getContext());
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003515 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3516 return I;
3517 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3518 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3519 }
3520};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003521} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003522
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003523// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3524// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003525// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003526Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003527 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3528 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003529 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3530 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003531 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003532 if (!Op->isShift())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003533 Together = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003534
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003535 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3536 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003537 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003538 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003539 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003540 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003541 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003542 }
3543 break;
3544 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003545 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3546 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003547
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003548 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3549 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003550 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003551 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003552 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003553 }
3554 break;
3555 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003556 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003557 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3558 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3559 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003560 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003561
3562 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003563 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003564 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3565 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3566 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003567 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003568
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003569 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3570 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3571 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3572 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3573 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3574 // no effect.
3575 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3576 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3577 return &TheAnd;
3578 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003579 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003580 Value *NewAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003581 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003582 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003583 }
3584 }
3585 }
3586 }
3587 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003588
3589 case Instruction::Shl: {
3590 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3591 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3592 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003593 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003594 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003595 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003596 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(*Context, AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003597
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003598 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3599 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003600 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3601 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003602 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3603 return &TheAnd;
3604 }
3605 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003606 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003607 case Instruction::LShr:
3608 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003609 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3610 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3611 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3612 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003613 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003614 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003615 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003616 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(*Context, AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003617
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003618 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3619 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003620 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3621 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3622 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3623 return &TheAnd;
3624 }
3625 break;
3626 }
3627 case Instruction::AShr:
3628 // Signed shr.
3629 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3630 // with an and.
3631 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003632 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003633 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003634 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003635 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(*Context, AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003636 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003637 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003638 // Make the argument unsigned.
3639 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003640 ShVal = Builder->CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS, Op->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003641 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003642 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003643 }
3644 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003645 }
3646 return 0;
3647}
3648
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003649
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003650/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3651/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003652/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3653/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003654/// insert new instructions.
3655Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003656 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3657 Instruction &IB) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003658 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003659 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003660 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003661
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003662 if (Inside) {
3663 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003664 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003665
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003666 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003667 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003668 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003669 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003670 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003671 }
3672
3673 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003674 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003675 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003676 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003677 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003678 }
3679
3680 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003681 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003682
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003683 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003684 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003685 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003686 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3687 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003688 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003689 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003690
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003691 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3692 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003693 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003694 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003695 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003696 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003697}
3698
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003699// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3700// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3701// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3702// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003703static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003704 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003705 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3706 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003707
3708 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003709 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003710 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003711 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003712 return true;
3713}
3714
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003715/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3716/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3717/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003718///
3719/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3720/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3721/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3722///
3723/// return (A +/- B).
3724///
3725Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003726 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003727 Instruction &I) {
3728 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3729 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3730 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3731
3732 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3733
3734 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3735 default: return 0;
3736 case Instruction::And:
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003737 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003738 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003739 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3740 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3741 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003742 break;
3743
3744 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3745 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3746 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003747 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003748 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003749 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003750 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003751 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003752 break;
3753 }
3754 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003755 return 0;
3756 case Instruction::Or:
3757 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003758 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003759 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3760 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003761 && ConstantExpr::getAnd(N, Mask)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003762 break;
3763 return 0;
3764 }
3765
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003766 if (isSub)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003767 return Builder->CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3768 return Builder->CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003769}
3770
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003771/// FoldAndOfICmps - Fold (icmp)&(icmp) if possible.
3772Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I,
3773 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003774 Value *Val, *Val2;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003775 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
3776 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3777
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003778 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 B, C2).
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00003779 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003780 m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00003781 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003782 m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003783 return 0;
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003784
3785 // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3786 // where C is a power of 2
3787 if (LHSCst == RHSCst && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3788 LHSCst->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003789 Value *NewOr = Builder->CreateOr(Val, Val2);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003790 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, LHSCst);
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003791 }
3792
3793 // From here on, we only handle:
3794 // (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
3795 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
3796
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003797 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
3798 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3799 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3800 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
3801 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
3802 return 0;
3803
3804 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) & (sgt x, C2).
3805 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
3806 return 0;
3807
3808 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003809 bool ShouldSwap;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003810 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3811 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3812 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003813 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003814 else
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003815 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
3816
3817 if (ShouldSwap) {
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003818 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3819 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3820 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3821 }
3822
3823 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
3824 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3825 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
3826 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3827 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3828 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
3829 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3830
3831 switch (LHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003832 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003833 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
3834 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003835 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003836 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3837 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3838 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003839 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003840 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3841 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3842 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3843 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3844 }
3845 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3846 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003847 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003848 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003849 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003850 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Val, LHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003851 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3852 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003853 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003854 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Val, LHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003855 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3856 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3857 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3858 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3859 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3860 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003861 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003862 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003863 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(Val, AddCST, Val->getName()+".off");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003864 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003865 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003866 }
3867 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3868 }
3869 break;
3870 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3871 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003872 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003873 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3874 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003875 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003876 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3877 break;
3878 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3879 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
3880 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3881 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3882 break;
3883 }
3884 break;
3885 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3886 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003887 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003888 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3889 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003890 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003891 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3892 break;
3893 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3894 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
3895 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3896 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3897 break;
3898 }
3899 break;
3900 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3901 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003902 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003903 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3904 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3905 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3906 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3907 break;
3908 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003909 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003910 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003911 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00003912 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) -> (X-14) <u 1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003913 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003914 RHSCst, false, true, I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003915 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3916 break;
3917 }
3918 break;
3919 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3920 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003921 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003922 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3923 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3924 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3925 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3926 break;
3927 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003928 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003929 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003930 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00003931 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) -> (X-14) s< 1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003932 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003933 RHSCst, true, true, I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003934 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3935 break;
3936 }
3937 break;
3938 }
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003939
3940 return 0;
3941}
3942
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00003943Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS,
3944 FCmpInst *RHS) {
3945
3946 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
3947 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
3948 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
3949 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3950 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3951 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3952 // false.
3953 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003954 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003955 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD,
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00003956 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
3957 }
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00003958
3959 // Handle vector zeros. This occurs because the canonical form of
3960 // "fcmp ord x,x" is "fcmp ord x, 0".
3961 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(LHS->getOperand(1)) &&
3962 isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(RHS->getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003963 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD,
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00003964 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00003965 return 0;
3966 }
3967
3968 Value *Op0LHS = LHS->getOperand(0), *Op0RHS = LHS->getOperand(1);
3969 Value *Op1LHS = RHS->getOperand(0), *Op1RHS = RHS->getOperand(1);
3970 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC = LHS->getPredicate(), Op1CC = RHS->getPredicate();
3971
3972
3973 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
3974 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
3975 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
3976 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
3977 }
3978
3979 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
3980 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
3981 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003982 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00003983
3984 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE || Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003985 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00003986 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
3987 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3988 if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
3989 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3990
3991 bool Op0Ordered;
3992 bool Op1Ordered;
3993 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
3994 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
3995 if (Op1Pred == 0) {
3996 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3997 std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
3998 std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
3999 }
4000 if (Op0Pred == 0) {
4001 // uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
4002 // ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
4003 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
4004 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4005
4006 // uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
4007 // uno && ord -> false
4008 if (!Op0Ordered)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004009 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004010 // ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
4011 return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred,
4012 Op0LHS, Op0RHS, Context));
4013 }
4014 }
4015
4016 return 0;
4017}
4018
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004019
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004020Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004021 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004022 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004023
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004024 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004025 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004026
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004027 // and X, X = X
4028 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004029 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004030
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004031 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00004032 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004033 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
4034 return &I;
4035 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00004036 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004037 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00004038 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004039 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4040 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00004041 }
4042 }
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004043
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004044 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00004045 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
4046 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004047
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004048 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004049 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004050 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004051 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
4052 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
4053 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
4054 case Instruction::Xor:
4055 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004056 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
4057 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4058 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
4059 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004060 Value *NewRHS = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
4061 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004062 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004063 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004064 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00004065 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004066 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
4067 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004068 Value *NewLHS = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
4069 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004070 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004071 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
4072 }
4073 }
4074
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004075 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004076 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004077 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
4078 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4079 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4080 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004081 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004082 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004083 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004084 break;
4085
4086 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004087 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
4088 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4089 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4090 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004091 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004092
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00004093 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
4094 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
4095 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4096 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
4097 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
4098 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
4099
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004100 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00004101 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
4102 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004103 Value *NewNeg = Builder->CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004104 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
4105 }
4106 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004107 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00004108
4109 case Instruction::Shl:
4110 case Instruction::LShr:
4111 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
4112 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00004113 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004114 Value *NewICmp =
4115 Builder->CreateICmpEQ(Op0RHS, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00004116 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
4117 }
4118 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004119 }
4120
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00004121 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004122 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004123 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004124 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004125 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
4126 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
4127 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
4128 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004129 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004130 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004131 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004132 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
4133 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004134 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
4135 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
4136 // other simplifications.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004137 Value *NewCast = Builder->CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00004138 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
4139 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004140 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004141 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004142 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004143 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004144 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4145 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
4146 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004147 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004148 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004149 // trunc(C1)&C2
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004150 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
4151 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004152 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004153 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00004154 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004155
4156 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4157 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004158 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004159 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004160 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4161 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4162 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00004163 }
4164
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004165 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
4166 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004167
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004168 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004169 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004170
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004171 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004172 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004173 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
4174 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004175 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004176 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004177
4178 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004179 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004180 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004181 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
4182 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004183
4184 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004185 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004186 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004187 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004188 }
4189 }
4190
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004191 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004192 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
4193 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004194
4195 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004196 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004197 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004198 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004199 }
4200 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004201
4202 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004203 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004204 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
4205 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
4206 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4207 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
4208 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
4209 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
4210 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4211 }
4212 }
Bill Wendling7f0ef6b2008-11-30 13:08:13 +00004213
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004214 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004215 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004216 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
4217 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
4218 std::swap(A, B);
4219 }
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004220 if (A == Op0) // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
4221 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Builder->CreateNot(B, "tmp"));
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004222 }
Bill Wendling7f0ef6b2008-11-30 13:08:13 +00004223
4224 // (A&((~A)|B)) -> A&B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004225 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op1)), m_Value(A))) ||
4226 match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op1)))))
Chris Lattnerd8aafcb2008-12-01 05:16:26 +00004227 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op1);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004228 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op0)), m_Value(A))) ||
4229 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op0)))))
Chris Lattnerd8aafcb2008-12-01 05:16:26 +00004230 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004231 }
4232
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004233 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
4234 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004235 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004236 return R;
4237
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004238 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
4239 if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4240 return Res;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00004241 }
4242
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004243 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004244 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
4245 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
4246 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
4247 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00004248 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() &&
4249 SrcTy->isIntOrIntVector() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004250 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004251 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4252 I.getType(), TD) &&
4253 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4254 I.getType(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004255 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4256 Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004257 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004258 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004259 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004260
4261 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004262 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4263 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4264 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004265 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4266 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004267 Value *NewOp =
4268 Builder->CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0), SI1->getOperand(0),
4269 SI0->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004270 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004271 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004272 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004273 }
4274
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004275 // If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004276 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004277 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4278 if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfFCmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4279 return Res;
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004280 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004281
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004282 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004283}
4284
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004285/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
4286/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
4287/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
4288/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
4289/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
4290/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
4291/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
4292/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
4293/// match.
4294///
4295/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
4296/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
4297/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
4298/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
4299/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
4300/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
4301///
4302/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
4303/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
4304/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
4305/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
4306/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
4307///
4308static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
4309 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
4310 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4311 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
4312 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4313 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4314 ByteValues) ||
4315 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4316 ByteValues);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004317 }
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004318
4319 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
4320 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
4321 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4322 unsigned ShAmt =
4323 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
4324 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
4325 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
4326 return true;
4327
4328 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
4329 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
4330 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
4331 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
4332 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
4333 } else {
4334 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
4335 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
4336 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattnerde17ddc2008-10-08 06:42:28 +00004337 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004338 }
4339
4340 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4341 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4342
4343 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4344 ByteValues);
4345 }
4346
4347 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
4348 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
4349 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
4350 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4351 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
4352 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
4353 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
4354 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
4355
4356 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
4357 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
4358 // the and mask is.
4359 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
4360 continue;
4361
4362 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
4363 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
4364 if (MaskB == 0) {
4365 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
4366 continue;
4367 }
4368
4369 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
4370 if (MaskB != Byte)
4371 return true;
4372
4373 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
4374 }
4375
4376 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4377 ByteValues);
4378 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004379 }
4380
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004381 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4382 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4383 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4384 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4385 // their ultimate destination.
4386 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4387 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004388
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004389 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4390 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4391 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4392 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4393 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4394 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4395 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4396 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4397 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4398 return true;
4399 } else {
4400 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4401 return true;
4402 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004403
4404 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4405 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004406 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004407 return true;
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004408 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004409 return false;
4410}
4411
4412/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4413/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4414Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004415 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004416 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4417 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4418 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004419 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004420
4421 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4422 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00004423 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004424 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004425
4426 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004427 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4428 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004429 return 0;
4430
4431 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4432 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4433 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4434
4435 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4436 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4437 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4438 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004439 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004440 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004441 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004442 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004443}
4444
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004445/// MatchSelectFromAndOr - We have an expression of the form (A&C)|(B&D). Check
4446/// If A is (cond?-1:0) and either B or D is ~(cond?-1,0) or (cond?0,-1), then
4447/// we can simplify this expression to "cond ? C : D or B".
4448static Instruction *MatchSelectFromAndOr(Value *A, Value *B,
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004449 Value *C, Value *D,
4450 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004451 // If A is not a select of -1/0, this cannot match.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004452 Value *Cond = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004453 if (!match(A, m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Value(Cond))))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004454 return 0;
4455
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004456 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | (B&(cond?0:-1)) -> cond ? C : B.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004457 if (match(D, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004458 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004459 if (match(D, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond)))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004460 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
4461 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | ((cond?0:-1)&D) -> cond ? C : D.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004462 if (match(B, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004463 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004464 if (match(B, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond)))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004465 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004466 return 0;
4467}
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004468
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004469/// FoldOrOfICmps - Fold (icmp)|(icmp) if possible.
4470Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I,
4471 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
4472 Value *Val, *Val2;
4473 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
4474 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4475
4476 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 B, C2).
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004477 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004478 m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004479 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004480 m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004481 return 0;
4482
4483 // From here on, we only handle:
4484 // (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
4485 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
4486
4487 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
4488 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4489 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4490 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
4491 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
4492 return 0;
4493
4494 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4495 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
4496 return 0;
4497
4498 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
4499 bool ShouldSwap;
4500 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
4501 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
4502 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
4503 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
4504 else
4505 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
4506
4507 if (ShouldSwap) {
4508 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4509 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4510 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4511 }
4512
4513 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
4514 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4515 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
4516 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4517 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
4518 // equal.
4519 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4520
4521 switch (LHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004522 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004523 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4524 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004525 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004526 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004527 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004528 // (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004529 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004530 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(Val, AddCST, Val->getName()+".off");
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004531 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getSub(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004532 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004533 }
4534 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4535 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4536 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
4537 break;
4538 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4539 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4540 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4541 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4542 }
4543 break;
4544 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
4545 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004546 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004547 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4548 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4549 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
4550 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4551 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4552 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4553 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004554 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004555 }
4556 break;
4557 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4558 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004559 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004560 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4561 break;
4562 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) -> (X-13) u> 2
4563 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4564 // this can cause overflow.
4565 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4566 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004567 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004568 false, false, I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004569 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4570 break;
4571 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4572 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4573 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4574 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4575 break;
4576 }
4577 break;
4578 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4579 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004580 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004581 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4582 break;
4583 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) -> (X-13) s> 2
4584 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4585 // this can cause overflow.
4586 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4587 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004588 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004589 true, false, I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004590 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4591 break;
4592 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4593 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4594 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4595 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4596 break;
4597 }
4598 break;
4599 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4600 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004601 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004602 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4603 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4604 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4605 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4606 break;
4607 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4608 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004609 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004610 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4611 break;
4612 }
4613 break;
4614 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4615 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004616 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004617 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4618 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4619 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4620 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4621 break;
4622 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4623 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004624 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004625 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4626 break;
4627 }
4628 break;
4629 }
4630 return 0;
4631}
4632
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004633Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS,
4634 FCmpInst *RHS) {
4635 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4636 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4637 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
4638 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4639 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4640 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4641 // true.
4642 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004643 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004644
4645 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4646 // rest.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004647 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO,
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004648 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
4649 }
4650
4651 // Handle vector zeros. This occurs because the canonical form of
4652 // "fcmp uno x,x" is "fcmp uno x, 0".
4653 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(LHS->getOperand(1)) &&
4654 isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(RHS->getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004655 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO,
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004656 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
4657
4658 return 0;
4659 }
4660
4661 Value *Op0LHS = LHS->getOperand(0), *Op0RHS = LHS->getOperand(1);
4662 Value *Op1LHS = RHS->getOperand(0), *Op1RHS = RHS->getOperand(1);
4663 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC = LHS->getPredicate(), Op1CC = RHS->getPredicate();
4664
4665 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4666 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4667 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4668 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4669 }
4670 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4671 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4672 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004673 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC,
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004674 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4675 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE || Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004676 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004677 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4679 if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4680 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4681 bool Op0Ordered;
4682 bool Op1Ordered;
4683 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4684 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4685 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
4686 // If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
4687 // or'ed predicates.
4688 Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred,
4689 Op0LHS, Op0RHS, Context);
4690 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
4691 return I;
4692 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
4693 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
4694 }
4695 }
4696 return 0;
4697}
4698
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004699/// FoldOrWithConstants - This helper function folds:
4700///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004701/// ((A | B) & C1) | (B & C2)
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004702///
4703/// into:
4704///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004705/// (A & C1) | B
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004706///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004707/// when the XOR of the two constants is "all ones" (-1).
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004708Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004709 Value *A, Value *B, Value *C) {
Bill Wendlingdda74e02008-12-02 05:06:43 +00004710 ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4711 if (!CI1) return 0;
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004712
Bill Wendling286a0542008-12-02 06:24:20 +00004713 Value *V1 = 0;
4714 ConstantInt *CI2 = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004715 if (!match(Op, m_And(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CI2)))) return 0;
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004716
Bill Wendling29976b92008-12-02 06:18:11 +00004717 APInt Xor = CI1->getValue() ^ CI2->getValue();
4718 if (!Xor.isAllOnesValue()) return 0;
4719
Bill Wendling286a0542008-12-02 06:24:20 +00004720 if (V1 == A || V1 == B) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004721 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateAnd((V1 == A) ? B : A, CI1);
Bill Wendlingd16c6e92008-12-02 06:22:04 +00004722 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NewOp, V1);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004723 }
4724
4725 return 0;
4726}
4727
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004728Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004729 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004730 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004731
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004732 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004733 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004734
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004735 // or X, X = X
4736 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004737 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004738
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004739 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4740 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004741 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
4742 return &I;
4743 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4744 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4745 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4746 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4747 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4748 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
4749 }
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004750 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004751
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004752 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004753 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004754 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004755 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004756 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004757 isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004758 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004759 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004760 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00004761 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004762 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004763
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004764 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004765 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004766 isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004767 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004768 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004769 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00004770 ConstantInt::get(*Context, C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004771 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004772
4773 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4774 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004775 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004776 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004777 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4778 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4779 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004780 }
4781
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004782 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4783 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004784
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004785 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004786 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4787 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004788 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004789 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4790 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4791
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004792 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4793 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004794 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4795 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4796 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4797 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004798 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4799 return BSwap;
4800 }
4801
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004802 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004803 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004804 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004805 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004806 Value *NOr = Builder->CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004807 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004808 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004809 }
4810
4811 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004812 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004813 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004814 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004815 Value *NOr = Builder->CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004816 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004817 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004818 }
4819
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004820 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004821 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004822 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4823 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004824 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4825 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4826 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4827 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4828 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4829 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4830 // replace with V+N.
4831 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4832 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004833 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004834 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4835 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4836 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4837 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4838 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4839 }
4840 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4841 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004842 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004843 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4844 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4845 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4846 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4847 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4848 }
4849 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004850 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004851 }
4852
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004853 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4854 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004855 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4856 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4857 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4858 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4859 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4860 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4861 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4862 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4863 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4864
4865 if (V1) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004866 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004867 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004868 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004869 }
Dan Gohmanb493b272008-10-28 22:38:57 +00004870
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004871 // (A & (C0?-1:0)) | (B & ~(C0?-1:0)) -> C0 ? A : B, and commuted variants
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004872 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(A, B, C, D, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004873 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004874 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(B, A, D, C, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004875 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004876 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(C, B, A, D, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004877 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004878 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(D, A, B, C, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004879 return Match;
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004880
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004881 // ((A&~B)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004882 if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(D))) &&
4883 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(A)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004884 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, D);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004885 // ((~B&A)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004886 if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(D))) &&
4887 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(C)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004888 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, D);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004889 // ((A&~B)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004890 if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(B))) &&
4891 match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(A)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004892 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004893 // ((~B&A)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004894 if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(B))) &&
4895 match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(C)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004896 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, B);
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004897 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004898
4899 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004900 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4901 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4902 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004903 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4904 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004905 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0), SI1->getOperand(0),
4906 SI0->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004907 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004908 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004909 }
4910 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004911
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004912 // ((A|B)&1)|(B&-2) -> (A&1) | B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004913 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C))) ||
4914 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))) {
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004915 Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op1, A, B, C);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004916 if (Ret) return Ret;
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004917 }
4918 // (B&-2)|((A|B)&1) -> (A&1) | B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004919 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C))) ||
4920 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))) {
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004921 Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op0, A, B, C);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004922 if (Ret) return Ret;
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004923 }
4924
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004925 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004926 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004927 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004928 } else {
4929 A = 0;
4930 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004931 // Note, A is still live here!
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004932 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004933 if (Op0 == B)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004934 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004935
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004936 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004937 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004938 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(A, B, I.getName()+".demorgan");
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004939 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004940 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004941 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004942
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004943 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4944 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004945 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004946 return R;
4947
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004948 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
4949 if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4950 return Res;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004951 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004952
4953 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004954 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004955 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004956 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004957 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4958 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4959 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00004960 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() &&
4961 SrcTy->isIntOrIntVector() &&
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004962 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4963 // generated.
4964 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4965 I.getType(), TD) &&
4966 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4967 I.getType(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004968 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4969 Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004970 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004971 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004972 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004973 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004974 }
4975
4976
4977 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4978 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004979 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4980 if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfFCmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4981 return Res;
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004982 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004983
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004984 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004985}
4986
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004987namespace {
4988
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004989// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4990struct XorSelf {
4991 Value *RHS;
4992 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4993 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4994 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4995 return &Xor;
4996 }
4997};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004998
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004999}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005000
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005001Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00005002 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005003 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005004
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00005005 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
5006 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
5007 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
5008 // idiom (misuse).
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005009 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005010 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00005011 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005012
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005013 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005014 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00005015 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005016 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005017 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00005018
5019 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5020 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005021 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
5022 return &I;
5023 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType()))
5024 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
5025 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005026
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005027 // Is this a ~ operation?
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005028 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005029 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
5030 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
5031 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
5032 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
5033 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005034 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
5035 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005036 Value *NotY =
5037 Builder->CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
5038 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005039 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005040 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005041 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005042 }
5043 }
5044 }
5045 }
5046
5047
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005048 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005049 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context) && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Bill Wendling3479be92009-01-01 01:18:23 +00005050 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005051 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005052 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005053 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00005054
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005055 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005056 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005057 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
5058 }
5059
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005060 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
5061 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
5062 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
5063 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
5064 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005065 if ((Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) &&
5066 (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode,
5067 ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
5068 Op0C->getDestTy()))) {
5069 CI->setPredicate(CI->getInversePredicate());
5070 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, CI, Op0C->getType());
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005071 }
5072 }
5073 }
5074 }
5075
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005076 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00005077 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005078 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
5079 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005080 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
5081 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005082 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005083 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005084 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00005085
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005086 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00005087 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00005088 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005089 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005090 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005091 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005092 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005093 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005094 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00005095 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00005096 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005097 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(*Context,
5098 RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005099 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00005100
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005101 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005102 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
5103 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00005104 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005105 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005106 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
5107 // NewRHS.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005108 Constant *CommonBits = ConstantExpr::getAnd(Op0CI, RHS);
5109 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
5110 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00005111 Worklist.Add(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005112 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
5113 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
5114 return &I;
5115 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00005116 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005117 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00005118 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005119
5120 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5121 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005122 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005123 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00005124 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5125 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5126 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005127 }
5128
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005129 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005130 if (X == Op1)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005131 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005132
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005133 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005134 if (X == Op0)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005135 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005136
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005137
5138 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
5139 if (Op1I) {
5140 Value *A, *B;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005141 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005142 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005143 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005144 I.swapOperands();
5145 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005146 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005147 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005148 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005149 }
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005150 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005151 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // A^(A^B) == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005152 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op0)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005153 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // A^(B^A) == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005154 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005155 Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00005156 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005157 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00005158 std::swap(A, B);
5159 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005160 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005161 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
5162 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
5163 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00005164 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005165 }
5166
5167 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
5168 if (Op0I) {
5169 Value *A, *B;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005170 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005171 Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005172 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
5173 std::swap(A, B);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005174 if (B == Op1) // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
5175 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Builder->CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"));
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005176 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005177 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // (A^B)^A == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005178 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op1)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005179 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // (B^A)^A == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005180 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005181 Op0I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005182 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
5183 std::swap(A, B);
5184 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00005185 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005186 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Builder->CreateNot(A, "tmp"), Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005187 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005188 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005189 }
5190
5191 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
5192 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
5193 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
5194 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5195 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005196 Value *NewOp =
5197 Builder->CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op1I->getOperand(0),
5198 Op0I->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005199 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005200 Op1I->getOperand(1));
5201 }
5202
5203 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
5204 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5205 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005206 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5207 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005208 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005209 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005210 }
5211 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005212 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5213 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005214 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005215 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005216 }
5217
5218 // (A & B)^(C & D)
5219 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005220 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5221 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005222 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
5223 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5224 if (A == C)
5225 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
5226 else if (A == D)
5227 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
5228 else if (B == C)
5229 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
5230 else if (B == D)
5231 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
5232
5233 if (X) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005234 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005235 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005236 }
5237 }
5238 }
5239
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005240 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
5241 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005242 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00005243 return R;
5244
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005245 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005246 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005247 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005248 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
5249 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00005250 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005251 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005252 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
5253 I.getType(), TD) &&
5254 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
5255 I.getType(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005256 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
5257 Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005258 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005259 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005260 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005261 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005262
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005263 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005264}
5265
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005266static ConstantInt *ExtractElement(Constant *V, Constant *Idx,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005267 LLVMContext *Context) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005268 return cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getExtractElement(V, Idx));
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005269}
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005270
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005271static bool HasAddOverflow(ConstantInt *Result,
5272 ConstantInt *In1, ConstantInt *In2,
5273 bool IsSigned) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00005274 if (IsSigned)
5275 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5276 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5277 else
5278 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5279 else
5280 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005281}
5282
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005283/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005284/// overflowed for this type.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005285static bool AddWithOverflow(Constant *&Result, Constant *In1,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005286 Constant *In2, LLVMContext *Context,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005287 bool IsSigned = false) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005288 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(In1, In2);
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005289
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005290 if (const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(In1->getType())) {
5291 for (unsigned i = 0, e = VTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005292 Constant *Idx = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005293 if (HasAddOverflow(ExtractElement(Result, Idx, Context),
5294 ExtractElement(In1, Idx, Context),
5295 ExtractElement(In2, Idx, Context),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005296 IsSigned))
5297 return true;
5298 }
5299 return false;
5300 }
5301
5302 return HasAddOverflow(cast<ConstantInt>(Result),
5303 cast<ConstantInt>(In1), cast<ConstantInt>(In2),
5304 IsSigned);
5305}
5306
5307static bool HasSubOverflow(ConstantInt *Result,
5308 ConstantInt *In1, ConstantInt *In2,
5309 bool IsSigned) {
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005310 if (IsSigned)
5311 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5312 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5313 else
5314 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5315 else
5316 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
5317}
5318
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005319/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
5320/// overflowed for this type.
5321static bool SubWithOverflow(Constant *&Result, Constant *In1,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005322 Constant *In2, LLVMContext *Context,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005323 bool IsSigned = false) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005324 Result = ConstantExpr::getSub(In1, In2);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005325
5326 if (const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(In1->getType())) {
5327 for (unsigned i = 0, e = VTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005328 Constant *Idx = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005329 if (HasSubOverflow(ExtractElement(Result, Idx, Context),
5330 ExtractElement(In1, Idx, Context),
5331 ExtractElement(In2, Idx, Context),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005332 IsSigned))
5333 return true;
5334 }
5335 return false;
5336 }
5337
5338 return HasSubOverflow(cast<ConstantInt>(Result),
5339 cast<ConstantInt>(In1), cast<ConstantInt>(In2),
5340 IsSigned);
5341}
5342
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005343/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
5344/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
5345/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
5346static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00005347 TargetData &TD = *IC.getTargetData();
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005348 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005349 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType(I.getContext());
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005350 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005351
5352 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005353 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005354 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005355
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00005356 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
5357 ++i, ++GTI) {
5358 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005359 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005360 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
5361 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
5362
5363 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5364 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5365 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
5366
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005367 Result = IC.Builder->CreateAdd(Result,
5368 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
5369 GEP->getName()+".offs");
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005370 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005371 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005372
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005373 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005374 Constant *OC =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005375 ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
5376 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005377 // Emit an add instruction.
5378 Result = IC.Builder->CreateAdd(Result, Scale, GEP->getName()+".offs");
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005379 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005380 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005381 // Convert to correct type.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005382 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy)
5383 Op = IC.Builder->CreateIntCast(Op, IntPtrTy, true, Op->getName()+".c");
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005384 if (Size != 1) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005385 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005386 // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
5387 Op = IC.Builder->CreateMul(Op, Scale, GEP->getName()+".idx");
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005388 }
5389
5390 // Emit an add instruction.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005391 Result = IC.Builder->CreateAdd(Op, Result, GEP->getName()+".offs");
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005392 }
5393 return Result;
5394}
5395
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005396
Dan Gohman8f080f02009-07-17 22:16:21 +00005397/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return a value that can be used to compare
5398/// the *offset* implied by a GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we
5399/// want to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can
5400/// be complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be
5401/// legal to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32).
5402/// This later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed
5403/// to generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005404///
5405/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
5406///
5407static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
5408 InstCombiner &IC) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00005409 TargetData &TD = *IC.getTargetData();
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005410 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
5411
5412 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
5413 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
5414 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
5415 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
5416 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
5417 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
5418 int64_t Offset = 0;
5419 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5420 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
5421 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5422 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5423
5424 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5425 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5426 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5427 } else {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005428 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005429 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5430 }
5431 } else {
5432 // Found our variable index.
5433 break;
5434 }
5435 }
5436
5437 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
5438 // evaluate it the general way.
5439 if (i == e) return 0;
5440
5441 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
5442 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
5443 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005444 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005445
5446 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
5447 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5448 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
5449 if (!CI) return 0;
5450
5451 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5452 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5453
5454 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5455 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5456 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5457 } else {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005458 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005459 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5460 }
5461 }
5462
5463 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
5464 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
5465 // the index.
5466 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
5467 if (Offset == 0) {
5468 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
5469 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
5470 // computation crosses zero.
5471 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005472 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx,
5473 TD.getIntPtrType(VariableIdx->getContext()),
Daniel Dunbar460f6562009-07-26 09:48:23 +00005474 VariableIdx->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005475 return VariableIdx;
5476 }
5477
5478 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
5479 // the pointer size, so get it.
5480 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
5481
5482 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
5483 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
5484
5485 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
5486 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
5487 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
5488 // multiple of the variable scale.
5489 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
5490 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
5491 return 0;
5492
5493 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005494 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType(VariableIdx->getContext());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005495 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005496 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005497 true /*SExt*/,
Daniel Dunbar460f6562009-07-26 09:48:23 +00005498 VariableIdx->getName(), &I);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005499 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005500 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005501}
5502
5503
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005504/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005505/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005506Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(GEPOperator *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005507 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
5508 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005509 // Look through bitcasts.
5510 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
5511 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005512
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005513 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005514 if (TD && PtrBase == RHS && GEPLHS->isInBounds()) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005515 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005516 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005517 // know pointers can't overflow since the gep is inbounds. See if we can
5518 // output an optimized form.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005519 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5520
5521 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
5522 if (Offset == 0)
5523 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005524 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005525 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005526 } else if (GEPOperator *GEPRHS = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005527 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
5528 // compare the base pointer.
5529 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
5530 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005531 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00005532 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005533 if (IndicesTheSame)
5534 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5535 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5536 IndicesTheSame = false;
5537 break;
5538 }
5539
5540 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5541 if (IndicesTheSame)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005542 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005543 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005544
5545 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5546 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005547 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005548 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005549
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005550 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5551 bool AllZeros = true;
5552 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5553 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5554 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5555 AllZeros = false;
5556 break;
5557 }
5558 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005559 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5560 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005561
5562 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005563 AllZeros = true;
5564 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5565 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5566 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5567 AllZeros = false;
5568 break;
5569 }
5570 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005571 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005572
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005573 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5574 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5575 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5576 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5577 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5578 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005579 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5580 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005581 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005582 NumDifferences = 2;
5583 break;
5584 } else {
5585 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5586 DiffOperand = i;
5587 }
5588 }
5589
5590 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5591 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005592 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005593 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005594
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005595 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005596 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5597 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005598 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005599 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005600 }
5601 }
5602
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005603 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005604 // the result to fold to a constant!
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00005605 if (TD &&
5606 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005607 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5608 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
5609 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5610 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005611 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005612 }
5613 }
5614 return 0;
5615}
5616
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005617/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5618///
5619Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5620 Instruction *LHSI,
5621 Constant *RHSC) {
5622 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5623 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5624
5625 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5626 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005627 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005628 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5629
5630 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5631 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5632 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005633 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005634
5635 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005636 bool LHSUnsigned = isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI);
5637 if (LHSUnsigned)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005638 ++InputSize;
5639
5640 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5641 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5642 return 0;
5643
5644 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5645 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5646 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5647 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5648
5649 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5650 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005651 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected predicate!");
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005652 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005653 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ:
5654 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ;
5655 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005656 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005657 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT:
5658 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5659 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005660 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005661 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE:
5662 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5663 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005664 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005665 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT:
5666 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5667 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005668 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005669 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE:
5670 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5671 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005672 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005673 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE:
5674 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5675 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005676 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005677 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005678 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005679 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005680 }
5681
5682 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5683
5684 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5685
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005686 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005687 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005688 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005689
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005690 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5691 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5692 // and large values.
5693 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5694 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5695 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5696 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
5697 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5698 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005699 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
5700 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005701 }
5702 } else {
5703 // If the RHS value is > UnsignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles
5704 // +INF and large values.
5705 APFloat UMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5706 UMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getMaxValue(IntWidth), false,
5707 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5708 if (UMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // umax < 13123.0
5709 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5710 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005711 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
5712 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005713 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005714 }
5715
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005716 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5717 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5718 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5719 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5720 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5721 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
5722 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5723 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005724 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
5725 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005726 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005727 }
5728
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005729 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] or
5730 // [0, UMAX], but it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by
5731 // casting the FP value to the integer value and back, checking for equality.
5732 // Don't do this for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005733 Constant *RHSInt = LHSUnsigned
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005734 ? ConstantExpr::getFPToUI(RHSC, IntTy)
5735 : ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005736 if (!RHS.isZero()) {
5737 bool Equal = LHSUnsigned
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005738 ? ConstantExpr::getUIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) == RHSC
5739 : ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) == RHSC;
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005740 if (!Equal) {
5741 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust
5742 // the compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards
5743 // zero at this point.
5744 switch (Pred) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005745 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer comparison!");
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005746 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005747 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005748 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005749 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005750 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5751 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5752 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> false
5753 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005754 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005755 break;
5756 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5757 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5758 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5759 if (RHS.isNegative())
5760 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5761 break;
5762 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5763 // (float)int < -4.4 --> false
5764 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5765 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005766 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005767 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE;
5768 break;
5769 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5770 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5771 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5772 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5773 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5774 break;
5775 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5776 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5777 // (float)int > -4.4 --> true
5778 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005779 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005780 break;
5781 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5782 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5783 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5784 if (RHS.isNegative())
5785 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5786 break;
5787 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5788 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> true
5789 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5790 if (!RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005791 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005792 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
5793 break;
5794 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5795 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5796 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5797 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5798 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5799 break;
5800 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005801 }
5802 }
5803
5804 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5805 // comparison.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005806 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005807}
5808
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005809Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5810 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005811 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005812
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005813 // Fold trivial predicates.
5814 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005815 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 0));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005816 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005817 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005818
5819 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5820 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5821 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005822 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown predicate!");
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005823 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5824 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5825 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005826 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005827 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5828 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5829 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005830 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 0));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005831
5832 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5833 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5834 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5835 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5836 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5837 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005838 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005839 return &I;
5840
5841 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5842 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5843 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5844 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5845 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5846 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005847 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005848 return &I;
5849 }
5850 }
5851
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005852 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005853 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005854
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005855 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5856 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005857 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5858 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5859 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5860 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005861 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005862 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5863 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5864 // True if unordered.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005865 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005866 }
5867 }
5868
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005869 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5870 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5871 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005872 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5873 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5874 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5875 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00005876 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I, true))
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005877 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005878 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005879 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5880 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5881 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5882 return NV;
5883 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005884 case Instruction::Select:
5885 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5886 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5887 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5888 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5889 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5890 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5891 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005892 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005893 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005894 Op2 = Builder->CreateFCmp(I.getPredicate(),
5895 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC, I.getName());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005896 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5897 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005898 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005899 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005900 Op1 = Builder->CreateFCmp(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(1),
5901 RHSC, I.getName());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005902 }
5903 }
5904
5905 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005906 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005907 break;
5908 }
5909 }
5910
5911 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5912}
5913
5914Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5915 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5916 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5917 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5918
5919 // icmp X, X
5920 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005921 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(),
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005922 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005923
5924 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005925 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005926
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005927 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005928 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Chris Lattnerbbc33852009-10-05 02:47:47 +00005929 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005930 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
Chris Lattnerbbc33852009-10-05 02:47:47 +00005931 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005932 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005933 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005934 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005935
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005936 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005937 if (Ty == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005938 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005939 default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005940 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005941 Value *Xor = Builder->CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005942 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005943 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005944 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005945 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005946
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005947 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005948 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005949 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005950 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005951 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005952 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005953 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005954 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5955 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005956 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005957 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005958 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005959 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
5960 }
5961 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5962 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
5963 // FALL THROUGH
5964 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005965 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005966 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005967 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005968 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5969 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
5970 // FALL THROUGH
5971 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005972 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005973 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
5974 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005975 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005976 }
5977
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00005978 unsigned BitWidth = 0;
5979 if (TD)
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00005980 BitWidth = TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Ty->getScalarType());
5981 else if (Ty->isIntOrIntVector())
5982 BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00005983
5984 bool isSignBit = false;
5985
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005986 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005987 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky579214a2009-02-27 06:37:39 +00005988 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005989
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005990 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5991 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005992 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005993 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005994 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005995 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005996
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005997 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
5998 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
5999 // them being folded in the code below.
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006000 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
6001 default: break;
6002 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
6003 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006004 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006005 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006006 AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006007 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
6008 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006009 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006010 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006011 AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006012 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6013 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006014 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006015 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006016 SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006017 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6018 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006019 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006020 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006021 SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006022 }
6023
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006024 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006025 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006026 bool UnusedBit;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006027 isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
6028 }
6029
6030 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
6031 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
6032 if (BitWidth != 0) {
6033 APInt Op0KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), Op0KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6034 APInt Op1KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), Op1KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6035
6036 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I.getOperandUse(0),
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006037 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
6038 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006039 Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne, 0))
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006040 return &I;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006041 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I.getOperandUse(1),
6042 APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
6043 Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne, 0))
6044 return &I;
6045
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006046 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006047 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
6048 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006049 APInt Op0Min(BitWidth, 0), Op0Max(BitWidth, 0);
6050 APInt Op1Min(BitWidth, 0), Op1Max(BitWidth, 0);
6051 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
6052 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne,
6053 Op0Min, Op0Max);
6054 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne,
6055 Op1Min, Op1Max);
6056 } else {
6057 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne,
6058 Op0Min, Op0Max);
6059 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne,
6060 Op1Min, Op1Max);
6061 }
6062
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006063 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
6064 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
6065 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006066 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0) && Op0Min == Op0Max)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006067 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006068 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Op0Min), Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006069 if (!isa<Constant>(Op1) && Op1Min == Op1Max)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006070 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006071 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Op1Min));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006072
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006073 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
6074 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006075 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00006076 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown icmp opcode!");
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006077 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006078 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min) || Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max))
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006079 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006080 break;
6081 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006082 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min) || Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max))
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006083 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006084 break;
6085 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006086 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min)) // A <u B -> true if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006087 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006088 if (Op0Min.uge(Op1Max)) // A <u B -> false if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006089 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006090 if (Op1Min == Op0Max) // A <u B -> A != B if max(A) == min(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006091 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006092 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6093 if (Op1Max == Op0Min+1) // A <u C -> A == C-1 if min(A)+1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006094 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006095 SubOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006096
6097 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
6098 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006099 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006100 Constant::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006101 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006102 break;
6103 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006104 if (Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max)) // A >u B -> true if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006105 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006106 if (Op0Max.ule(Op1Min)) // A >u B -> false if max(A) <= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006107 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006108
6109 if (Op1Max == Op0Min) // A >u B -> A != B if min(A) == max(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006110 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006111 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6112 if (Op1Min == Op0Max-1) // A >u C -> A == C+1 if max(a)-1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006113 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006114 AddOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006115
6116 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
6117 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006118 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006119 Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006120 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006121 break;
6122 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006123 if (Op0Max.slt(Op1Min)) // A <s B -> true if max(A) < min(C)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006124 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006125 if (Op0Min.sge(Op1Max)) // A <s B -> false if min(A) >= max(C)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006126 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006127 if (Op1Min == Op0Max) // A <s B -> A != B if max(A) == min(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006128 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006129 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6130 if (Op1Max == Op0Min+1) // A <s C -> A == C-1 if min(A)+1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006131 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006132 SubOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006133 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006134 break;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006135 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
6136 if (Op0Min.sgt(Op1Max)) // A >s B -> true if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006137 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006138 if (Op0Max.sle(Op1Min)) // A >s B -> false if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006139 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006140
6141 if (Op1Max == Op0Min) // A >s B -> A != B if min(A) == max(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006142 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006143 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6144 if (Op1Min == Op0Max-1) // A >s C -> A == C+1 if max(A)-1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006145 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006146 AddOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006147 }
6148 break;
6149 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6150 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_SGE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6151 if (Op0Min.sge(Op1Max)) // A >=s B -> true if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006152 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006153 if (Op0Max.slt(Op1Min)) // A >=s B -> false if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006154 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006155 break;
6156 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
6157 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_SLE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6158 if (Op0Max.sle(Op1Min)) // A <=s B -> true if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006159 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006160 if (Op0Min.sgt(Op1Max)) // A <=s B -> false if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006161 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006162 break;
6163 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6164 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_UGE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6165 if (Op0Min.uge(Op1Max)) // A >=u B -> true if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006166 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006167 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min)) // A >=u B -> false if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006168 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006169 break;
6170 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
6171 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_ULE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6172 if (Op0Max.ule(Op1Min)) // A <=u B -> true if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006173 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006174 if (Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max)) // A <=u B -> false if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006175 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006176 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006177 }
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006178
6179 // Turn a signed comparison into an unsigned one if both operands
6180 // are known to have the same sign.
6181 if (I.isSignedPredicate() &&
6182 ((Op0KnownZero.isNegative() && Op1KnownZero.isNegative()) ||
6183 (Op0KnownOne.isNegative() && Op1KnownOne.isNegative())))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006184 return new ICmpInst(I.getUnsignedPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006185 }
6186
6187 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
6188 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
6189 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
6190 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
6191 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
6192 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
6193 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
6194 if (I.hasOneUse())
6195 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
6196 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
6197 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
6198 return 0;
6199
6200 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
6201 // can be folded into the comparison.
6202 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006203 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00006204 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006205 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00006206 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006207 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
6208 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006209 }
6210
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006211 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006212 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
6213 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
6214 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006215 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
6216 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006217 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006218 bool isAllZeros = true;
6219 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
6220 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
6221 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
6222 isAllZeros = false;
6223 break;
6224 }
6225 if (isAllZeros)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006226 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006227 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006228 }
6229 break;
6230
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006231 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00006232 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and icmp are in the same
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00006233 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
6234 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
6235 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00006236 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I, true))
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00006237 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006238 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006239 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006240 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
6241 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
6242 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
6243 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
6244 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6245 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6246 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006247 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006248 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006249 Op2 = Builder->CreateICmp(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(2),
6250 RHSC, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006251 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
6252 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006253 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006254 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006255 Op1 = Builder->CreateICmp(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(1),
6256 RHSC, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006257 }
6258 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00006259
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006260 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00006261 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006262 break;
6263 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006264 case Instruction::Malloc:
6265 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
6266 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
6267 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00006268 Worklist.Add(LHSI);
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00006269 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
6270 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
6271 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
6272 }
6273 break;
6274 case Instruction::Call:
6275 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
6276 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
6277 if (isMalloc(LHSI) && LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6278 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
6279 Worklist.Add(LHSI);
6280 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
6281 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
6282 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
6283 }
6284 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006285 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006286 }
6287
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006288 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00006289 if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006290 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006291 return NI;
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00006292 if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006293 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
6294 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006295 return NI;
6296
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006297 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006298 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
6299 // now.
6300 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
6301 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
6302 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006303 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
6304 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006305 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006306
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006307 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
6308 // so eliminate it as well.
6309 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
6310 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006311
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006312 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006313 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006314 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006315 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006316 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006317 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00006318 Op1 = Builder->CreateBitCast(Op1, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006319 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006320 }
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006321 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006322 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006323 }
6324
6325 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006326 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00006327 // This comes up when you have code like
6328 // int X = A < B;
6329 // if (X) ...
6330 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006331 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
6332 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006333 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006334 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00006335 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006336
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006337 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
6338 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6339 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006340 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006341 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1)) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00006342 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006343 default: break;
6344 case Instruction::Add:
6345 case Instruction::Sub:
6346 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006347 if (I.isEquality()) // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006348 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006349 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006350 // icmp u/s (a ^ signbit), (b ^ signbit) --> icmp s/u a, b
6351 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
6352 if (CI->getValue().isSignBit()) {
6353 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = I.isSignedPredicate()
6354 ? I.getUnsignedPredicate()
6355 : I.getSignedPredicate();
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006356 return new ICmpInst(Pred, Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006357 Op1I->getOperand(0));
6358 }
6359
6360 if (CI->getValue().isMaxSignedValue()) {
6361 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = I.isSignedPredicate()
6362 ? I.getUnsignedPredicate()
6363 : I.getSignedPredicate();
6364 Pred = I.getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006365 return new ICmpInst(Pred, Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006366 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006367 }
6368 }
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006369 break;
6370 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006371 if (!I.isEquality())
6372 break;
6373
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006374 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
6375 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
6376 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
6377 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
6378 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006379 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(*Context,
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006380 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
6381 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006382 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006383 Value *And1 = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0), Mask);
6384 Value *And2 = Builder->CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0), Mask);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006385 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006386 }
6387 }
6388 break;
6389 }
6390 }
6391 }
6392 }
6393
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006394 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
6395 { Value *A, *B;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006396 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
6397 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006398 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006399 }
6400
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00006401 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006402 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006403
6404 // -x == -y --> x == y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006405 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
6406 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006407 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006408
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006409 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006410 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
6411 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006412 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006413 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006414 }
6415
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006416 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006417 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006418 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006419 if (match(B, m_ConstantInt(C1)) &&
6420 match(D, m_ConstantInt(C2)) && Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006421 Constant *NC =
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006422 ConstantInt::get(*Context, C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006423 Value *Xor = Builder->CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
6424 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, Xor);
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006425 }
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006426
6427 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006428 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
6429 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
6430 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
6431 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006432 }
6433 }
6434
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006435 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006436 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006437 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
6438 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006439 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006440 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006441 }
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006442
6443 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006444 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006445 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006446 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006447
6448 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006449 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006450 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006451 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006452
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006453 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
6454 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006455 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6456 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006457 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
6458
6459 if (A == C) {
6460 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
6461 } else if (A == D) {
6462 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
6463 } else if (B == C) {
6464 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
6465 } else if (B == D) {
6466 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
6467 }
6468
6469 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006470 Op1 = Builder->CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp");
6471 Op1 = Builder->CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006472 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006473 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006474 return &I;
6475 }
6476 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006477 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006478 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006479}
6480
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006481
6482/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
6483/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
6484Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
6485 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
6486 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6487 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
6488
6489 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
6490 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
6491 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
6492 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
6493 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
6494 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
6495 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
6496 // if it finds it.
6497 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
6498 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
6499 return 0;
6500 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006501 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006502 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
6503 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
6504 if (DivRHS->isOne())
6505 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
6506 // with INT_MIN.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006507
6508 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
6509 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
6510 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
6511 // instead of computing a divide.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006512 Constant *Prod = ConstantExpr::getMul(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006513
6514 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
6515 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
6516 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006517 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
6518 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006519
6520 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006521 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006522
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006523 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
6524 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
6525 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
6526 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
6527 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
6528 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
6529 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
6530 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00006531 Constant *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006532
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006533 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006534 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006535 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006536 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6537 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006538 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, Context, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006539 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006540 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006541 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006542 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006543 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006544 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006545 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
6546 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6547 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006548 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, Context, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006549 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006550 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006551 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006552 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
6553 if (!LoOverflow) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006554 ConstantInt* DivNeg =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006555 cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006556 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg, Context,
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006557 true) ? -1 : 0;
6558 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006559 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006560 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006561 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006562 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006563 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006564 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006565 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
6566 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
6567 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
6568 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006569 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006570 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006571 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006572 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006573 if (!LoOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006574 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound,
6575 DivRHS, Context, true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006576 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006577 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
6578 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman7f85fbd2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00006579 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006580 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, Context, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006581 }
6582
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006583 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
6584 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006585 }
6586
6587 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006588 switch (Pred) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00006589 default: llvm_unreachable("Unhandled icmp opcode!");
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006590 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
6591 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006592 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006593 else if (HiOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006594 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006595 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
6596 else if (LoOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006597 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006598 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
6599 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006600 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006601 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
6602 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006603 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006604 else if (HiOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006605 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006606 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
6607 else if (LoOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006608 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006609 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6610 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006611 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006612 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
6613 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006614 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006615 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006616 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006617 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006618 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006619 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
6620 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006621 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006622 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006623 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006624 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006625 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006626 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006627 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006628 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006629 }
6630}
6631
6632
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006633/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
6634///
6635Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
6636 Instruction *LHSI,
6637 ConstantInt *RHS) {
6638 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
6639
6640 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnera80d6682009-01-09 07:47:06 +00006641 case Instruction::Trunc:
6642 if (ICI.isEquality() && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6643 // Simplify icmp eq (trunc x to i8), 42 -> icmp eq x, 42|highbits if all
6644 // of the high bits truncated out of x are known.
6645 unsigned DstBits = LHSI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(),
6646 SrcBits = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6647 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(SrcBits, SrcBits-DstBits));
6648 APInt KnownZero(SrcBits, 0), KnownOne(SrcBits, 0);
6649 ComputeMaskedBits(LHSI->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
6650
6651 // If all the high bits are known, we can do this xform.
6652 if ((KnownZero|KnownOne).countLeadingOnes() >= SrcBits-DstBits) {
6653 // Pull in the high bits from known-ones set.
6654 APInt NewRHS(RHS->getValue());
6655 NewRHS.zext(SrcBits);
6656 NewRHS |= KnownOne;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006657 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006658 ConstantInt::get(*Context, NewRHS));
Chris Lattnera80d6682009-01-09 07:47:06 +00006659 }
6660 }
6661 break;
6662
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00006663 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006664 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6665 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
6666 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006667 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
6668 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006669 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
6670
6671 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
6672 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
6673 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
6674 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00006675 Worklist.Add(LHSI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006676 return &ICI;
6677 }
6678
6679 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
6680 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
6681
6682 // If so, the new one isn't.
6683 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
6684
6685 if (isTrueIfPositive)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006686 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006687 SubOne(RHS));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006688 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006689 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006690 AddOne(RHS));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006691 }
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006692
6693 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6694 // (icmp u/s (xor A SignBit), C) -> (icmp s/u A, (xor C SignBit))
6695 if (!ICI.isEquality() && XorCST->getValue().isSignBit()) {
6696 const APInt &SignBit = XorCST->getValue();
6697 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.isSignedPredicate()
6698 ? ICI.getUnsignedPredicate()
6699 : ICI.getSignedPredicate();
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006700 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006701 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV ^ SignBit));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006702 }
6703
6704 // (icmp u/s (xor A ~SignBit), C) -> (icmp s/u (xor C ~SignBit), A)
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006705 if (!ICI.isEquality() && XorCST->getValue().isMaxSignedValue()) {
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006706 const APInt &NotSignBit = XorCST->getValue();
6707 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.isSignedPredicate()
6708 ? ICI.getUnsignedPredicate()
6709 : ICI.getSignedPredicate();
6710 Pred = ICI.getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006711 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006712 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV ^ NotSignBit));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006713 }
6714 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006715 }
6716 break;
6717 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
6718 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
6719 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
6720 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6721
6722 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
6723 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
6724 // produced, eliminating a cast.
6725 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
6726 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
6727 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
6728 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
6729 // bit would not work.
6730 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00006731 (ICI.isEquality() ||
6732 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006733 uint32_t BitWidth =
6734 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
6735 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
6736 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
6737 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
6738 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006739 Value *NewAnd =
6740 Builder->CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006741 ConstantInt::get(*Context, NewCST), LHSI->getName());
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006742 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006743 ConstantInt::get(*Context, NewCI));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006744 }
6745 }
6746
6747 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
6748 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
6749 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
6750 // access.
6751 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
6752 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
6753 Shift = 0;
6754
6755 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
6756 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
6757 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
6758 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
6759
6760 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
6761 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
6762 // rights, as they sign-extend.
6763 if (ShAmt) {
6764 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
6765 if (!CanFold) {
6766 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
6767 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
6768 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6769 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
6770
6771 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6772 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
6773 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
6774 CanFold = true;
6775 }
6776
6777 if (CanFold) {
6778 Constant *NewCst;
6779 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006780 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006781 else
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006782 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006783
6784 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
6785 // compared.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006786 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006787 NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006788 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
6789 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
6790 // result is always true or false now.
6791 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006792 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006793 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006794 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006795 } else {
6796 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
6797 Constant *NewAndCST;
6798 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006799 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006800 else
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006801 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006802 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
6803 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00006804 Worklist.Add(Shift); // Shift is dead.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006805 return &ICI;
6806 }
6807 }
6808 }
6809
6810 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
6811 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
6812 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
6813 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
Chris Lattnere8e49212009-03-25 00:28:58 +00006814 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
6815 !isa<Constant>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006816 // Compute C << Y.
6817 Value *NS;
6818 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006819 NS = Builder->CreateShl(AndCST, Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006820 } else {
6821 // Insert a logical shift.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006822 NS = Builder->CreateLShr(AndCST, Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006823 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006824
6825 // Compute X & (C << Y).
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006826 Value *NewAnd =
6827 Builder->CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006828
6829 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
6830 return &ICI;
6831 }
6832 }
6833 break;
6834
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006835 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
6836 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6837 if (!ShAmt) break;
6838
6839 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6840
6841 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6842 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6843 // simplified.
6844 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6845 break;
6846
6847 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6848 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6849 // comparison cannot succeed.
6850 Constant *Comp =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006851 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006852 ShAmt);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006853 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6854 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00006855 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context), IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006856 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6857 }
6858
6859 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6860 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6861 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6862 Constant *Mask =
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006863 ConstantInt::get(*Context, APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006864 TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006865
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006866 Value *And =
6867 Builder->CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006868 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006869 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006870 }
6871 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006872
6873 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6874 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6875 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6876 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6877 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006878 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(*Context, APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006879 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006880 Value *And =
6881 Builder->CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0), Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006882 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006883 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006884 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006885 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006886 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006887
6888 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006889 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006890 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006891 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006892 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006893
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006894 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6895 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6896 // simplified.
6897 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6898 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6899 break;
6900
6901 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006902
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006903 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6904 // comparison cannot succeed.
6905 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6906 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6907 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6908 else
6909 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6910
6911 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6912 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00006913 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context), IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006914 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6915 }
6916
6917 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6918 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6919 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006920 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6921 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006922 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006923 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006924 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006925 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006926
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006927 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006928 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6929 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006930 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(*Context, Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006931
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006932 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
6933 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006934 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006935 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006936 }
6937 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006938 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006939
6940 case Instruction::SDiv:
6941 case Instruction::UDiv:
6942 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6943 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6944 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6945 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6946 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6947 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006948 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6949 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6950 DivRHS))
6951 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006952 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006953
6954 case Instruction::Add:
6955 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6956
6957 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6958 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6959 if (!LHSC) break;
6960 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6961
6962 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6963 .subtract(LHSV);
6964
6965 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6966 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006967 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006968 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getUpper()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006969 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006970 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006971 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getLower()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006972 }
6973 } else {
6974 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006975 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006976 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getUpper()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006977 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006978 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006979 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getLower()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006980 }
6981 }
6982 }
6983 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006984 }
6985
6986 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6987 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6988 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6989
6990 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6991 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6992 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6993 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6994 case Instruction::SRem:
6995 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6996 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6997 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6998 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006999 Value *NewRem =
7000 Builder->CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
7001 BO->getName());
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007002 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007003 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007004 }
7005 }
7006 break;
7007 case Instruction::Add:
7008 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
7009 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
7010 if (BO->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007011 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007012 ConstantExpr::getSub(RHS, BOp1C));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007013 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
7014 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
7015 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
7016 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
7017
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00007018 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007019 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00007020 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007021 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007022 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007023 Value *Neg = Builder->CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007024 Neg->takeName(BO);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007025 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007026 }
7027 }
7028 break;
7029 case Instruction::Xor:
7030 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
7031 // the explicit xor.
7032 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007033 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007034 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007035
7036 // FALLTHROUGH
7037 case Instruction::Sub:
7038 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
7039 if (RHSV == 0)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007040 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007041 BO->getOperand(1));
7042 break;
7043
7044 case Instruction::Or:
7045 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
7046 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
7047 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007048 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
7049 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007050 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007051 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007052 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007053 }
7054 break;
7055
7056 case Instruction::And:
7057 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
7058 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
7059 // comparison can never succeed!
7060 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007061 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007062 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007063 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007064
7065 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
7066 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007067 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007068 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007069 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007070
7071 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00007072 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007073 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007074 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007075 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
7076 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007077 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007078 }
7079
7080 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
7081 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
7082 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007083 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007084 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
7085 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007086 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007087 }
7088 }
7089 default: break;
7090 }
7091 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
7092 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
7093 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00007094 Worklist.Add(II);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007095 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007096 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV.byteSwap()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007097 return &ICI;
7098 }
7099 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007100 }
7101 return 0;
7102}
7103
7104/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
7105/// We only handle extending casts so far.
7106///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007107Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
7108 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007109 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
7110 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007111 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007112 Value *RHSCIOp;
7113
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007114 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
7115 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00007116 if (TD && LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
7117 TD->getPointerSizeInBits() ==
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007118 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
7119 Value *RHSOp = 0;
7120 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007121 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007122 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
7123 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
7124 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
7125 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00007126 RHSOp = Builder->CreateBitCast(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType());
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007127 }
7128
7129 if (RHSOp)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007130 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007131 }
7132
7133 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
7134 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007135 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
7136 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00007137 return 0;
7138
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007139 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
7140 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007141
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007142 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007143 // Not an extension from the same type?
7144 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007145 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
7146 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00007147
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007148 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00007149 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
7150 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
7151 return 0;
7152
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007153 // Deal with equality cases early.
7154 if (ICI.isEquality())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007155 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007156
7157 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
7158 // signed comparison.
7159 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007160 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007161
7162 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007163 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00007164 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007165
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007166 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
7167 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
7168 if (!CI)
7169 return 0;
7170
7171 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
7172 // reextended to DestTy.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007173 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
7174 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007175 Res1, DestTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007176
7177 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
7178 if (Res2 == CI) {
7179 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
7180 // For example, we might have:
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007181 // %A = sext i16 %X to i32
7182 // %B = icmp ugt i32 %A, 1330
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007183 // It is incorrect to transform this into
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007184 // %B = icmp ugt i16 %X, 1330
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007185 // because %A may have negative value.
7186 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007187 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
7188 // signless.
7189 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007190 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007191 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007192 }
7193
7194 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
7195 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
7196
7197 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
7198 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
7199 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007200 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007201 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007202 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007203
7204 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
7205 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
7206 Value *Result;
7207 if (isSignedCmp) {
7208 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00007209 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007210 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007211 else
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007212 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007213 } else {
7214 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
7215 if (isSignedExt) {
7216 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
7217 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007218 Constant *NegOne = Constant::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007219 Result = Builder->CreateICmpSGT(LHSCIOp, NegOne, ICI.getName());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007220 } else {
7221 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007222 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007223 }
7224 }
7225
7226 // Finally, return the value computed.
7227 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007228 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007229 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007230
7231 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
7232 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
7233 "ICmp should be folded!");
7234 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007235 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007236 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007237}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007238
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007239Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
7240 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
7241}
7242
7243Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
7244 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
7245}
7246
7247Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00007248 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
7249 return R;
7250
7251 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
7252
7253 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
7254 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
7255 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
7256 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
Dan Gohman0001e562009-02-24 02:00:40 +00007257
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007258 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
7259 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
7260 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())))
7261 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
7262
7263 // Arithmetic shifting an all-sign-bit value is a no-op.
7264 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op0);
7265 if (NumSignBits == Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())
7266 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Dan Gohman0001e562009-02-24 02:00:40 +00007267
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00007268 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007269}
7270
7271Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
7272 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007273 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007274
7275 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
7276 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007277 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
7278 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00007279 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007280
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007281 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
7282 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00007283 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007284 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007285 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007286 }
7287 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007288 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
7289 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
7290 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007291 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007292 }
7293
Dan Gohman9004c8a2009-05-21 02:28:33 +00007294 // See if we can fold away this shift.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007295 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Dan Gohman9004c8a2009-05-21 02:28:33 +00007296 return &I;
7297
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007298 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
7299 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
7300 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007301 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007302 return R;
7303
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007304 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007305 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
7306 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007307 return 0;
7308}
7309
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007310Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007311 BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +00007312 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007313
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007314 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
7315 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007316 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007317
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007318 // shl i32 X, 32 = 0 and srl i8 Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate
7319 // a signed shift.
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007320 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007321 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00007322 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007323 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007324 else {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007325 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007326 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00007327 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007328 }
7329
7330 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
7331 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
7332 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
7333 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007334 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007335 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007336
7337 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
7338 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
7339 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
7340 return R;
7341 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
7342 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
7343 return NV;
7344
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007345 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
7346 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
7347 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
7348 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
7349 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
7350 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
7351 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
7352 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
7353 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
7354 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
7355 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007356 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007357 // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
7358 Value *NSh = Builder->CreateBinOp(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,I.getName());
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007359
7360 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
7361 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
7362 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
7363 // other xforms later if dead.
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007364 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
7365 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007366 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
7367
7368 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
7369 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
7370 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
7371 // mask as appropriate.
7372 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
7373 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
7374 else {
7375 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
7376 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
7377 }
7378
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007379 // shift1 & 0x00FF
7380 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(*Context, MaskV),
7381 TI->getName());
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007382
7383 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
7384 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
7385 }
7386 }
7387
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007388 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007389 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
7390 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
7391 Value *V1, *V2;
7392 ConstantInt *CC;
7393 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007394 default: break;
7395 case Instruction::Add:
7396 case Instruction::And:
7397 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007398 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007399 // These operators commute.
7400 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007401 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007402 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1), m_Shr(m_Value(V1),
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007403 m_Specific(Op1)))) {
7404 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7405 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
7406 // (X + (Y << C))
7407 Value *X = Builder->CreateBinOp(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
7408 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007409 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007410 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context,
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007411 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007412 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007413
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007414 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007415 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00007416 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007417 match(Op0BOOp1,
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007418 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Specific(Op1)),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007419 m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007420 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007421 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7422 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
7423 Op0BO->getName());
7424 // X & (CC << C)
7425 Value *XM = Builder->CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
7426 V1->getName()+".mask");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007427 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007428 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007429 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007430
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007431 // FALL THROUGH.
7432 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007433 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007434 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007435 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0), m_Shr(m_Value(V1),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007436 m_Specific(Op1)))) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007437 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7438 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
7439 // (X + (Y << C))
7440 Value *X = Builder->CreateBinOp(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
7441 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007442 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007443 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context,
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007444 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007445 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007446
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00007447 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007448 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7449 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
7450 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007451 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007452 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
7453 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007454 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7455 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
7456 // X & (CC << C)
7457 Value *XM = Builder->CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
7458 V1->getName()+".mask");
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007459
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007460 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007461 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007462
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007463 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007464 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007465 }
7466
7467
7468 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
7469 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
7470 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
7471 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
7472 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
7473
7474 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007475 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00007476 case Instruction::Add:
7477 isValid = isLeftShift;
7478 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007479 case Instruction::Or:
7480 case Instruction::Xor:
7481 highBitSet = false;
7482 break;
7483 case Instruction::And:
7484 highBitSet = true;
7485 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007486 }
7487
7488 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
7489 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
7490 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
7491 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
7492 // operation.
7493 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00007494 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007495 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007496
7497 if (isValid) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007498 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007499
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007500 Value *NewShift =
7501 Builder->CreateBinOp(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007502 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007503
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007504 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007505 NewRHS);
7506 }
7507 }
7508 }
7509 }
7510
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007511 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007512 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
7513 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
7514 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007515
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007516 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007517 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007518 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
7519 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007520 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
7521 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
7522 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007523
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007524 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007525
7526 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
7527
7528 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00007529 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007530 // If this is oversized composite shift, then unsigned shifts get 0, ashr
7531 // saturates.
7532 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits) {
7533 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007534 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007535 AmtSum = TypeBits-1; // Saturate to 31 for i32 ashr.
7536 }
7537
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007538 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007539 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007540 }
7541
7542 if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
7543 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007544 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007545 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007546
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007547 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007548 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007549 }
7550
7551 if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
7552 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007553 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007554 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits)
7555 AmtSum = TypeBits-1;
7556
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007557 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007558
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007559 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007560 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007561 }
7562
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007563 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
7564 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
7565 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
7566 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
7567 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007568 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007569 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007570 }
7571 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
7572 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00007573 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007574 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007575 }
7576 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
7577 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
7578 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
7579 // generators.
7580 const Type *SExtType = 0;
7581 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007582 case 1 :
7583 case 8 :
7584 case 16 :
7585 case 32 :
7586 case 64 :
7587 case 128:
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007588 SExtType = IntegerType::get(*Context, Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007589 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007590 default: break;
7591 }
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007592 if (SExtType)
7593 return new SExtInst(Builder->CreateTrunc(X, SExtType, "sext"), Ty);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007594 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
7595 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007596 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007597
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007598 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007599 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7600 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7601 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007602 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007603
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007604 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007605 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
7606 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007607 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007608
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007609 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007610 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7611 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007612 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007613
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00007614 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007615 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
7616 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007617 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007618
7619 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
7620 } else {
7621 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007622 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007623
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007624 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007625 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7626 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7627 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007628 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateBinOp(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
7629 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007630
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007631 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007632 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
7633 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007634 }
7635
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007636 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007637 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7638 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007639 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007640
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00007641 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007642 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
7643 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007644 }
7645
7646 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007647 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007648 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007649 return 0;
7650}
7651
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007652
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007653/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
7654/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
7655/// X*Scale+Offset.
7656///
7657static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00007658 int &Offset, LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007659 assert(Val->getType() == Type::getInt32Ty(*Context) &&
7660 "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007661 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007662 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007663 Scale = 0;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007664 return ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007665 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
7666 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7667 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7668 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
7669 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
7670 Offset = 0;
7671 return I->getOperand(0);
7672 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
7673 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
7674 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
7675 Offset = 0;
7676 return I->getOperand(0);
7677 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7678 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
7679 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
7680 unsigned SubScale;
7681 Value *SubVal =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007682 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale,
7683 Offset, Context);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007684 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
7685 Scale = SubScale;
7686 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007687 }
7688 }
7689 }
7690
7691 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
7692 Scale = 1;
7693 Offset = 0;
7694 return Val;
7695}
7696
7697
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007698/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
7699/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007700Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007701 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007702 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007703
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007704 BuilderTy AllocaBuilder(*Builder);
7705 AllocaBuilder.SetInsertPoint(AI.getParent(), &AI);
7706
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007707 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
7708 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00007709
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007710 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
7711 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
7712 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
7713 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
7714 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
7715
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007716 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +00007717 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *User << '\n');
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007718 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007719 }
7720 }
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00007721
7722 // This requires TargetData to get the alloca alignment and size information.
7723 if (!TD) return 0;
7724
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007725 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
7726 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
7727 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
7728 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007729
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007730 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
7731 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007732 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7733
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007734 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
7735 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
Dale Johannesena0a66372009-03-05 00:39:02 +00007736 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds. (A reference
7737 // from a dbg.declare doesn't count as a use for this purpose.)
7738 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && !hasOneUsePlusDeclare(&AI) &&
7739 CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007740
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00007741 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(AllocElTy);
7742 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007743 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007744
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007745 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
7746 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007747 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
7748 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007749 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007750 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale,
7751 ArrayOffset, Context);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007752
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007753 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
7754 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007755 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
7756 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007757
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007758 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
7759 Value *Amt = 0;
7760 if (Scale == 1) {
7761 Amt = NumElements;
7762 } else {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007763 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Scale);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007764 // Insert before the alloca, not before the cast.
7765 Amt = AllocaBuilder.CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007766 }
7767
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007768 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007769 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Offset, true);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007770 Amt = AllocaBuilder.CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007771 }
7772
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007773 AllocationInst *New;
7774 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007775 New = AllocaBuilder.CreateMalloc(CastElTy, Amt);
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007776 else
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007777 New = AllocaBuilder.CreateAlloca(CastElTy, Amt);
7778 New->setAlignment(AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007779 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007780
Dale Johannesena0a66372009-03-05 00:39:02 +00007781 // If the allocation has one real use plus a dbg.declare, just remove the
7782 // declare.
7783 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(&AI)) {
7784 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
7785 }
7786 // If the allocation has multiple real uses, insert a cast and change all
7787 // things that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it
7788 // will die soon.
7789 else if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007790 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
7791 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007792 Value *NewCast = AllocaBuilder.CreateBitCast(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007793 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
7794 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007795 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
7796}
7797
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007798/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007799/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
7800/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
7801/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
7802/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
7803///
7804/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
7805/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007806///
7807/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
7808/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
7809/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
7810/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
7811/// efficiently truncated.
7812///
7813/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
7814/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
7815/// the final result.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007816bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007817 unsigned CastOpc,
7818 int &NumCastsRemoved){
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007819 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007820 if (isa<Constant>(V))
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007821 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007822
7823 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007824 if (!I) return false;
7825
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007826 const Type *OrigTy = V->getType();
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007827
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007828 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7829 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7830 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7831 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7832 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7833 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7834 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7835 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007836 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007837 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7838 return true;
7839 }
7840 }
7841
7842 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7843 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7844 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7845
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00007846 unsigned Opc = I->getOpcode();
7847 switch (Opc) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007848 case Instruction::Add:
7849 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007850 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007851 case Instruction::And:
7852 case Instruction::Or:
7853 case Instruction::Xor:
7854 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007855 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007856 NumCastsRemoved) &&
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007857 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007858 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007859
Eli Friedman070a9812009-07-13 22:46:01 +00007860 case Instruction::UDiv:
7861 case Instruction::URem: {
7862 // UDiv and URem can be truncated if all the truncated bits are zero.
7863 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
7864 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
7865 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth) {
7866 APInt Mask = APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth);
7867 if (MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0), Mask) &&
7868 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(1), Mask)) {
7869 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7870 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7871 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7872 NumCastsRemoved);
7873 }
7874 }
7875 break;
7876 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007877 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007878 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7879 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7880 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007881 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
7882 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits() &&
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007883 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007884 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007885 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007886 }
7887 break;
7888 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007889 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
7890 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
7891 // already zeros.
7892 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007893 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
7894 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007895 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007896 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007897 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
7898 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007899 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007900 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007901 }
7902 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007903 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007904 case Instruction::ZExt:
7905 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007906 case Instruction::Trunc:
7907 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00007908 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
7909 // of casts in the input.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00007910 if (Opc == CastOpc)
7911 return true;
7912
7913 // sext (zext ty1), ty2 -> zext ty2
Evan Cheng661d9c32009-01-15 17:09:07 +00007914 if (CastOpc == Instruction::SExt && Opc == Instruction::ZExt)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007915 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007916 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007917 case Instruction::Select: {
7918 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7919 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007920 NumCastsRemoved) &&
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007921 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007922 NumCastsRemoved);
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007923 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007924 case Instruction::PHI: {
7925 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7926 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7927 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7928 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007929 NumCastsRemoved))
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007930 return false;
7931 return true;
7932 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007933 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007934 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7935 break;
7936 }
7937
7938 return false;
7939}
7940
7941/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7942/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7943/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007944Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007945 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007946 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007947 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007948 isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007949
7950 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7951 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007952 Instruction *Res = 0;
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00007953 unsigned Opc = I->getOpcode();
7954 switch (Opc) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007955 case Instruction::Add:
7956 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007957 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007958 case Instruction::And:
7959 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007960 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007961 case Instruction::AShr:
7962 case Instruction::LShr:
Eli Friedman070a9812009-07-13 22:46:01 +00007963 case Instruction::Shl:
7964 case Instruction::UDiv:
7965 case Instruction::URem: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007966 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007967 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00007968 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)Opc, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007969 break;
7970 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007971 case Instruction::Trunc:
7972 case Instruction::ZExt:
7973 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007974 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007975 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7976 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007977 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7978 return I->getOperand(0);
7979
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007980 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007981 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007982 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007983 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007984 case Instruction::Select: {
7985 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
7986 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
7987 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
7988 break;
7989 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007990 case Instruction::PHI: {
7991 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7992 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7993 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7994 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7995 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7996 }
7997 Res = NPN;
7998 break;
7999 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008000 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008001 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008002 llvm_unreachable("Unreachable!");
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008003 break;
8004 }
8005
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008006 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008007 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
8008}
8009
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008010/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
8011Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00008012 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8013
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00008014 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008015 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00008016 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008017 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
8018 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
8019 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
8020 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008021 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00008022 }
8023 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00008024
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008025 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00008026 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
8027 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
8028 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008029
8030 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008031 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
8032 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
8033 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008034
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008035 return 0;
8036}
8037
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008038/// FindElementAtOffset - Given a type and a constant offset, determine whether
8039/// or not there is a sequence of GEP indices into the type that will land us at
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008040/// the specified offset. If so, fill them into NewIndices and return the
8041/// resultant element type, otherwise return null.
8042static const Type *FindElementAtOffset(const Type *Ty, int64_t Offset,
8043 SmallVectorImpl<Value*> &NewIndices,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008044 const TargetData *TD,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008045 LLVMContext *Context) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008046 if (!TD) return 0;
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008047 if (!Ty->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008048
8049 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
8050 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
8051 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008052 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType(*Context);
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008053 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008054 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(Ty)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008055 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
Chris Lattner31a69cb2009-01-11 20:41:36 +00008056 Offset -= FirstIdx*TySize;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008057
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008058 // Handle hosts where % returns negative instead of values [0..TySize).
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008059 if (Offset < 0) {
8060 --FirstIdx;
8061 Offset += TySize;
8062 assert(Offset >= 0);
8063 }
8064 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize && "Out of range offset");
8065 }
8066
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008067 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008068
8069 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
8070 while (Offset) {
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008071 // Indexing into tail padding between struct/array elements.
8072 if (uint64_t(Offset*8) >= TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008073 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008074
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008075 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(Ty)) {
8076 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008077 assert(Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes() &&
8078 "Offset must stay within the indexed type");
8079
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008080 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008081 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Elt));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008082
8083 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
8084 Ty = STy->getElementType(Elt);
Chris Lattner1c412d92009-01-11 20:23:52 +00008085 } else if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008086 uint64_t EltSize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(AT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008087 assert(EltSize && "Cannot index into a zero-sized array");
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008088 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008089 Offset %= EltSize;
Chris Lattner1c412d92009-01-11 20:23:52 +00008090 Ty = AT->getElementType();
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008091 } else {
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008092 // Otherwise, we can't index into the middle of this atomic type, bail.
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008093 return 0;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008094 }
8095 }
8096
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008097 return Ty;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008098}
8099
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008100/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
8101Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
8102 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8103
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008104 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008105 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
8106 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008107 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
8108 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
8109 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
8110 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00008111 Worklist.Add(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008112 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
8113 return &CI;
8114 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008115
8116 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
8117 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
8118 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
8119 // non-type-safe code.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008120 if (TD && GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008121 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
8122 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008123 ConstantInt *OffsetV =
8124 cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008125 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
8126
8127 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
8128 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
8129 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
8130 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008131 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008132 if (FindElementAtOffset(GEPIdxTy, Offset, NewIndices, TD, Context)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008133 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
8134 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
8135 // two.
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +00008136 Value *NGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(GEP)->isInBounds() ?
8137 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(OrigBase,
8138 NewIndices.begin(), NewIndices.end()) :
8139 Builder->CreateGEP(OrigBase, NewIndices.begin(), NewIndices.end());
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008140 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008141
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008142 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
8143 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
8144 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
8145 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008146 }
8147 }
8148 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008149 }
8150
8151 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8152}
8153
Chris Lattnerddfa57b2009-04-08 05:41:03 +00008154/// isSafeIntegerType - Return true if this is a basic integer type, not a crazy
8155/// type like i42. We don't want to introduce operations on random non-legal
8156/// integer types where they don't already exist in the code. In the future,
8157/// we should consider making this based off target-data, so that 32-bit targets
8158/// won't get i64 operations etc.
8159static bool isSafeIntegerType(const Type *Ty) {
8160 switch (Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
8161 case 8:
8162 case 16:
8163 case 32:
8164 case 64:
8165 return true;
8166 default:
8167 return false;
8168 }
8169}
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008170
Eli Friedmaneb7f7a82009-07-13 20:58:59 +00008171/// commonIntCastTransforms - This function implements the common transforms
8172/// for trunc, zext, and sext.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008173Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
8174 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8175 return Result;
8176
8177 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8178 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8179 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008180 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
8181 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008182
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008183 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
8184 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00008185 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(CI))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008186 return &CI;
8187
8188 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
8189 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008190 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
8191 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008192 return 0;
8193
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008194 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008195 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008196 // Only do this if the dest type is a simple type, don't convert the
8197 // expression tree to something weird like i93 unless the source is also
8198 // strange.
8199 if ((isSafeIntegerType(DestTy->getScalarType()) ||
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008200 !isSafeIntegerType(SrcI->getType()->getScalarType())) &&
8201 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008202 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008203 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008204 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
8205 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
8206 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
8207 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008208 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008209 bool DoXForm = false;
8210 bool JustReplace = false;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008211 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
8212 default:
8213 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
8214 // get here because of the check above.
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008215 llvm_unreachable("Unknown cast type");
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008216 case Instruction::Trunc:
8217 DoXForm = true;
8218 break;
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008219 case Instruction::ZExt: {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008220 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008221 if (!DoXForm && 0) {
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008222 // If it's unnecessary to issue an AND to clear the high bits, it's
8223 // always profitable to do this xform.
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008224 Value *TryRes = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy, false);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008225 APInt Mask(APInt::getBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize, DestBitSize));
8226 if (MaskedValueIsZero(TryRes, Mask))
8227 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, TryRes);
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008228
8229 if (Instruction *TryI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TryRes))
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008230 if (TryI->use_empty())
8231 EraseInstFromFunction(*TryI);
8232 }
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008233 break;
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008234 }
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008235 case Instruction::SExt: {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008236 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008237 if (!DoXForm && !isa<TruncInst>(SrcI) && 0) {
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008238 // If we do not have to emit the truncate + sext pair, then it's always
8239 // profitable to do this xform.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008240 //
8241 // It's not safe to eliminate the trunc + sext pair if one of the
8242 // eliminated cast is a truncate. e.g.
8243 // t2 = trunc i32 t1 to i16
8244 // t3 = sext i16 t2 to i32
8245 // !=
8246 // i32 t1
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008247 Value *TryRes = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy, true);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008248 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(TryRes);
8249 if (NumSignBits > (DestBitSize - SrcBitSize))
8250 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, TryRes);
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008251
8252 if (Instruction *TryI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TryRes))
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008253 if (TryI->use_empty())
8254 EraseInstFromFunction(*TryI);
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008255 }
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008256 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008257 }
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008258 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008259
8260 if (DoXForm) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +00008261 DEBUG(errs() << "ICE: EvaluateInDifferentType converting expression type"
8262 " to avoid cast: " << CI);
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008263 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
8264 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008265 if (JustReplace)
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008266 // Just replace this cast with the result.
8267 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008268
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008269 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
8270 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008271 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown cast type!");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008272 case Instruction::Trunc:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008273 // Just replace this cast with the result.
8274 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8275 case Instruction::ZExt: {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008276 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008277
8278 // If the high bits are already zero, just replace this cast with the
8279 // result.
8280 APInt Mask(APInt::getBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize, DestBitSize));
8281 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Res, Mask))
8282 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8283
8284 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008285 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(*Context,
8286 APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008287 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008288 }
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008289 case Instruction::SExt: {
8290 // If the high bits are already filled with sign bit, just replace this
8291 // cast with the result.
8292 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Res);
8293 if (NumSignBits > (DestBitSize - SrcBitSize))
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008294 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8295
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008296 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008297 return new SExtInst(Builder->CreateTrunc(Res, Src->getType()), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008298 }
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008299 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008300 }
8301 }
8302
8303 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
8304 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
8305
8306 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
8307 case Instruction::Add:
8308 case Instruction::Mul:
8309 case Instruction::And:
8310 case Instruction::Or:
8311 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00008312 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008313 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
8314 // Don't insert two casts unless at least one can be eliminated.
8315 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008316 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008317 Value *Op0c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op0, DestTy, Op0->getName());
8318 Value *Op1c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op1, DestTy, Op1->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008319 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008320 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008321 }
8322 }
8323
8324 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
8325 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
8326 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00008327 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context) &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008328 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008329 Value *New = Builder->CreateZExt(Op0, DestTy, Op0->getName());
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008330 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008331 ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008332 }
8333 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008334
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008335 case Instruction::Shl: {
8336 // Canonicalize trunc inside shl, if we can.
8337 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1);
8338 if (CI && DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
8339 CI->getLimitedValue(DestBitSize) < DestBitSize) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008340 Value *Op0c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op0, DestTy, Op0->getName());
8341 Value *Op1c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op1, DestTy, Op1->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008342 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008343 }
8344 break;
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008345 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008346 }
8347 return 0;
8348}
8349
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008350Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008351 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8352 return Result;
8353
8354 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8355 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008356 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
8357 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008358
8359 // Canonicalize trunc x to i1 -> (icmp ne (and x, 1), 0)
Eli Friedman191a0ae2009-07-18 09:21:25 +00008360 if (DestBitWidth == 1) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008361 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(Src->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008362 Src = Builder->CreateAnd(Src, One, "tmp");
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008363 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(Src->getType());
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00008364 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Src, Zero);
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008365 }
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008366
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008367 // Optimize trunc(lshr(), c) to pull the shift through the truncate.
8368 ConstantInt *ShAmtV = 0;
8369 Value *ShiftOp = 0;
8370 if (Src->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00008371 match(Src, m_LShr(m_Value(ShiftOp), m_ConstantInt(ShAmtV)))) {
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008372 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
8373
8374 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
8375 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
8376 if (MaskedValueIsZero(ShiftOp, Mask)) {
8377 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008378 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008379
8380 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
8381 // shift.
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008382 Value *V1 = Builder->CreateTrunc(ShiftOp, Ty, ShiftOp->getName());
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00008383 Value *V2 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(ShAmtV, Ty);
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008384 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008385 }
8386 }
8387
8388 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008389}
8390
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008391/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
8392/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
8393Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
8394 bool DoXform) {
8395 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
8396 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
8397 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
8398 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
8399 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
8400
8401 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
8402 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
8403 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
8404 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
8405 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8406
8407 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008408 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008409 In->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008410 In = Builder->CreateLShr(In, Sh, In->getName()+".lobit");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008411 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008412 In = Builder->CreateIntCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008413
8414 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008415 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008416 In = Builder->CreateXor(In, One, In->getName()+".not");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008417 }
8418
8419 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8420 }
8421
8422
8423
8424 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
8425 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8426 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
8427 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8428 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
8429 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8430 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
8431 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8432 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
8433 // This only works for EQ and NE
8434 ICI->isEquality()) {
8435 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
8436 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
8437 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8438 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
8439 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8440
8441 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
8442 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
8443 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8444
8445 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
8446 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
8447 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
8448 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008449 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context), isNE);
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00008450 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008451 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8452 }
8453
8454 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
8455 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
8456 if (ShiftAmt) {
8457 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
8458 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008459 In = Builder->CreateLShr(In, ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),ShiftAmt),
8460 In->getName()+".lobit");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008461 }
8462
8463 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008464 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008465 In = Builder->CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008466 }
8467
8468 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
8469 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8470 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008471 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008472 }
8473 }
8474 }
8475
8476 return 0;
8477}
8478
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008479Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008480 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
8481 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8482 return Result;
8483
8484 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8485
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008486 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
8487 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
8488 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
8489 if (TruncInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
8490 // Get the sizes of the types involved. We know that the intermediate type
8491 // will be smaller than A or C, but don't know the relation between A and C.
8492 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008493 unsigned SrcSize = A->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8494 unsigned MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8495 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008496 // If we're actually extending zero bits, then if
8497 // SrcSize < DstSize: zext(a & mask)
8498 // SrcSize == DstSize: a & mask
8499 // SrcSize > DstSize: trunc(a) & mask
8500 if (SrcSize < DstSize) {
8501 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008502 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(A->getType(), AndValue);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008503 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(A, AndConst, CSrc->getName()+".mask");
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008504 return new ZExtInst(And, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008505 }
8506
8507 if (SrcSize == DstSize) {
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008508 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008509 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, ConstantInt::get(A->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008510 AndValue));
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008511 }
8512 if (SrcSize > DstSize) {
8513 Value *Trunc = Builder->CreateTrunc(A, CI.getType(), "tmp");
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008514 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DstSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008515 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Trunc,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008516 ConstantInt::get(Trunc->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008517 AndValue));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008518 }
8519 }
8520
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008521 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
8522 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00008523
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008524 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
8525 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
8526 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
8527 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
8528 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
8529 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
8530 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
8531 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
8532 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008533 Value *LCast = Builder->CreateZExt(LHS, CI.getType(), LHS->getName());
8534 Value *RCast = Builder->CreateZExt(RHS, CI.getType(), RHS->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008535 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00008536 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008537 }
8538
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008539 // zext(trunc(t) & C) -> (t & zext(C)).
Dan Gohmana392c782009-06-17 23:17:05 +00008540 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && SrcI->hasOneUse())
8541 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1)))
8542 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0))) {
8543 Value *TI0 = TI->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008544 if (TI0->getType() == CI.getType())
8545 return
8546 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(TI0,
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00008547 ConstantExpr::getZExt(C, CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmana392c782009-06-17 23:17:05 +00008548 }
8549
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008550 // zext((trunc(t) & C) ^ C) -> ((t & zext(C)) ^ zext(C)).
8551 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor && SrcI->hasOneUse())
8552 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1)))
8553 if (BinaryOperator *And = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI->getOperand(0)))
8554 if (And->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && And->hasOneUse() &&
8555 And->getOperand(1) == C)
8556 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(And->getOperand(0))) {
8557 Value *TI0 = TI->getOperand(0);
8558 if (TI0->getType() == CI.getType()) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00008559 Constant *ZC = ConstantExpr::getZExt(C, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008560 Value *NewAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(TI0, ZC, "tmp");
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008561 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, ZC);
8562 }
8563 }
8564
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008565 return 0;
8566}
8567
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008568Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008569 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8570 return I;
8571
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008572 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8573
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008574 // Canonicalize sign-extend from i1 to a select.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008575 if (Src->getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008576 return SelectInst::Create(Src,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008577 Constant::getAllOnesValue(CI.getType()),
8578 Constant::getNullValue(CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008579
8580 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
8581 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +00008582 if (Operator::getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008583 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008584 unsigned OpBits = Op->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8585 unsigned MidBits = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8586 unsigned DestBits = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008587 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
8588
8589 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
8590 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
8591 // bits, it is already ready.
8592 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
8593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
8594 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
8595 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
8596 // bits, just sext from i32.
8597 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8598 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8599 } else {
8600 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
8601 // bits, just truncate to i32.
8602 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8603 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8604 }
8605 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008606
8607 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
8608 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
8609 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
8610 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
8611 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
8612 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
8613 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
8614 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
8615 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
8616 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
8617 // into:
8618 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
8619 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
8620 Value *A = 0;
8621 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
8622 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00008623 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008624 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
8625 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
8626 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008627 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8628 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008629 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008630 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008631 I = Builder->CreateShl(I, ShAmtV, CI.getName());
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008632 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
8633 }
8634 }
8635
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008636 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008637}
8638
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008639/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
8640/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008641static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008642 LLVMContext *Context) {
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008643 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008644 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008645 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
8646 if (!losesInfo)
Owen Anderson6f83c9c2009-07-27 20:59:43 +00008647 return ConstantFP::get(*Context, F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008648 return 0;
8649}
8650
8651/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
8652/// through it until we get the source value.
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008653static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V, LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008654 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
8655 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008656 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0), Context);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008657
8658 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
8659 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
8660 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
8661 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008662 if (CFP->getType() == Type::getPPC_FP128Ty(*Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008663 return V; // No constant folding of this.
8664 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008665 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008666 return V;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008667 if (CFP->getType() == Type::getDoubleTy(*Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008668 return V; // Won't shrink.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008669 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008670 return V;
8671 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
8672 }
8673
8674 return V;
8675}
8676
8677Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
8678 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8679 return I;
8680
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008681 // If we have fptrunc(fadd (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008682 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008683 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to fadd/fsub/fmul/fdiv as well as
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008684 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
8685 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
8686 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
8687 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
8688 default: break;
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008689 case Instruction::FAdd:
8690 case Instruction::FSub:
8691 case Instruction::FMul:
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008692 case Instruction::FDiv:
8693 case Instruction::FRem:
8694 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008695 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0), Context);
8696 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1), Context);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008697 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
8698 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008699 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008700 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
8701 // the cast, do this xform.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008702 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
8703 RHSTrunc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008704 LHSTrunc = Builder->CreateFPExt(LHSTrunc, CI.getType());
8705 RHSTrunc = Builder->CreateFPExt(RHSTrunc, CI.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008706 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008707 }
8708 }
8709 break;
8710 }
8711 }
8712 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008713}
8714
8715Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
8716 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8717}
8718
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008719Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008720 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8721 if (OpI == 0)
8722 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8723
8724 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
8725 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
8726 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8727 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8728 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8729 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8730 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8731 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008732 (int)FI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008733 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8734 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008735
8736 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008737}
8738
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008739Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008740 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8741 if (OpI == 0)
8742 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8743
8744 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
8745 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
8746 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8747 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8748 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8749 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8750 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8751 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008752 (int)FI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <=
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008753 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8754 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008755
8756 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008757}
8758
8759Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8760 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8761}
8762
8763Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8764 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8765}
8766
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008767Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(PtrToIntInst &CI) {
8768 // If the destination integer type is smaller than the intptr_t type for
8769 // this target, do a ptrtoint to intptr_t then do a trunc. This allows the
8770 // trunc to be exposed to other transforms. Don't do this for extending
8771 // ptrtoint's, because we don't know if the target sign or zero extends its
8772 // pointers.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008773 if (TD &&
8774 CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008775 Value *P = Builder->CreatePtrToInt(CI.getOperand(0),
8776 TD->getIntPtrType(CI.getContext()),
8777 "tmp");
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008778 return new TruncInst(P, CI.getType());
8779 }
8780
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008781 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008782}
8783
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008784Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008785 // If the source integer type is larger than the intptr_t type for
8786 // this target, do a trunc to the intptr_t type, then inttoptr of it. This
8787 // allows the trunc to be exposed to other transforms. Don't do this for
8788 // extending inttoptr's, because we don't know if the target sign or zero
8789 // extends to pointers.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008790 if (TD && CI.getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() >
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008791 TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008792 Value *P = Builder->CreateTrunc(CI.getOperand(0),
8793 TD->getIntPtrType(CI.getContext()), "tmp");
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008794 return new IntToPtrInst(P, CI.getType());
8795 }
8796
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008797 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8798 return I;
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008799
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008800 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008801}
8802
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008803Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008804 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
8805 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
8806 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8807 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8808 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
8809
Eli Friedman7e25d452009-07-13 20:53:00 +00008810 if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008811 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
8812 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008813 } else {
8814 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8815 return Result;
8816 }
8817
8818
8819 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
8820 // be replaced by the operand.
8821 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
8822 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
8823
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008824 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008825 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
8826 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
8827 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
8828
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00008829 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
8830 // required for changing types.
8831 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
8832 return 0;
8833
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00008834 // If we are casting a alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008835 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00008836 // There is no need to modify malloc calls because it is their bitcast that
8837 // needs to be cleaned up.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008838 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
8839 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
8840 return V;
8841
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00008842 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
8843 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008844 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008845 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008846 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
8847 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
8848 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
8849 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
8850 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
8851 ++NumZeros;
8852 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008853
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008854 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
8855 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
8856 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +00008857 return GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
8858 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008859 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008860 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00008861
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +00008862 if (const VectorType *DestVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(DestTy)) {
8863 if (DestVTy->getNumElements() == 1) {
8864 if (!isa<VectorType>(SrcTy)) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008865 Value *Elem = Builder->CreateBitCast(Src, DestVTy->getElementType());
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00008866 return InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(DestTy), Elem,
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008867 Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +00008868 }
8869 // FIXME: Canonicalize bitcast(insertelement) -> insertelement(bitcast)
8870 }
8871 }
8872
8873 if (const VectorType *SrcVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(SrcTy)) {
8874 if (SrcVTy->getNumElements() == 1) {
8875 if (!isa<VectorType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008876 Value *Elem =
8877 Builder->CreateExtractElement(Src,
8878 Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +00008879 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Elem, DestTy);
8880 }
8881 }
8882 }
8883
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008884 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
8885 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
8886 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
8887 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008888 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00008889 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
8890 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() &&
8891 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() ==
8892 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008893 CastInst *Tmp;
8894 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
8895 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
8896 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
8897 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
8898 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
8899 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
8900 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008901 Value *LHS = Builder->CreateBitCast(SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy);
8902 Value *RHS = Builder->CreateBitCast(SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008903 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
8904 // know the vector types match #elts.
8905 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00008906 }
8907 }
8908 }
8909 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00008910 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008911}
8912
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008913/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
8914/// %C = or %A, %B
8915/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
8916/// into:
8917/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
8918/// %D = or %A, %C
8919///
8920/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
8921/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
8922/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
8923///
8924static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
8925 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8926 case Instruction::Add:
8927 case Instruction::Mul:
8928 case Instruction::And:
8929 case Instruction::Or:
8930 case Instruction::Xor:
8931 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
8932 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
8933 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008934 case Instruction::LShr:
8935 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008936 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008937 default:
8938 return 0; // Cannot fold
8939 }
8940}
8941
8942/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8943/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008944static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008945 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008946 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008947 default: llvm_unreachable("This cannot happen!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008948 case Instruction::Add:
8949 case Instruction::Sub:
8950 case Instruction::Or:
8951 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008952 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008953 case Instruction::LShr:
8954 case Instruction::AShr:
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008955 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008956 case Instruction::And:
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008957 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008958 case Instruction::Mul:
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008959 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008960 }
8961}
8962
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008963/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
8964/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
8965Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
8966 Instruction *FI) {
8967 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
8968 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
8969 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008970 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008971 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
8972 return 0;
8973 } else {
8974 return 0; // unknown unary op.
8975 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008976
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008977 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008978 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +00008979 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008980 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008981 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008982 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008983 }
8984
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008985 // Only handle binary operators here.
8986 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008987 return 0;
8988
8989 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
8990 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
8991 bool MatchIsOpZero;
8992 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8993 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8994 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8995 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8996 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8997 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8998 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8999 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
9000 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
9001 MatchIsOpZero = false;
9002 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
9003 return 0;
9004 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
9005 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
9006 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
9007 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
9008 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9009 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
9010 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
9011 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
9012 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
9013 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9014 } else {
9015 return 0;
9016 }
9017
9018 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009019 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
9020 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009021 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
9022
9023 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
9024 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009025 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009026 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009027 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009028 }
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009029 llvm_unreachable("Shouldn't get here");
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00009030 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009031}
9032
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009033static bool isSelect01(Constant *C1, Constant *C2) {
9034 ConstantInt *C1I = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C1);
9035 if (!C1I)
9036 return false;
9037 ConstantInt *C2I = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C2);
9038 if (!C2I)
9039 return false;
9040 return (C1I->isZero() || C1I->isOne()) && (C2I->isZero() || C2I->isOne());
9041}
9042
9043/// FoldSelectIntoOp - Try fold the select into one of the operands to
9044/// facilitate further optimization.
9045Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectIntoOp(SelectInst &SI, Value *TrueVal,
9046 Value *FalseVal) {
9047 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
9048 // transformation we are doing here.
9049 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal)) {
9050 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
9051 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal)) {
9052 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
9053 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
9054 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
9055 OpToFold = 1;
9056 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
9057 OpToFold = 2;
9058 }
9059
9060 if (OpToFold) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009061 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI, Context);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009062 Value *OOp = TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold);
9063 // Avoid creating select between 2 constants unless it's selecting
9064 // between 0 and 1.
9065 if (!isa<Constant>(OOp) || isSelect01(C, cast<Constant>(OOp))) {
9066 Instruction *NewSel = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OOp, C);
9067 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
9068 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
9069 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
9070 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009071 llvm_unreachable("Unknown instruction!!");
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009072 }
9073 }
9074 }
9075 }
9076 }
9077
9078 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal)) {
9079 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
9080 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal)) {
9081 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
9082 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
9083 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
9084 OpToFold = 1;
9085 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
9086 OpToFold = 2;
9087 }
9088
9089 if (OpToFold) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009090 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI, Context);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009091 Value *OOp = FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold);
9092 // Avoid creating select between 2 constants unless it's selecting
9093 // between 0 and 1.
9094 if (!isa<Constant>(OOp) || isSelect01(C, cast<Constant>(OOp))) {
9095 Instruction *NewSel = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C, OOp);
9096 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
9097 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
9098 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
9099 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009100 llvm_unreachable("Unknown instruction!!");
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009101 }
9102 }
9103 }
9104 }
9105 }
9106
9107 return 0;
9108}
9109
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009110/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
9111/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
9112///
9113Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
9114 ICmpInst *ICI) {
9115 bool Changed = false;
9116 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
9117 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
9118 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
9119 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
9120 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
9121
9122 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
9123 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
9124 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
9125 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009126 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS)) {
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009127 switch (Pred) {
9128 default: break;
9129 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
9130 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
9131 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
9132 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
9133 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9134 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00009135 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009136 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
9137 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
9138 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9139 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
9140 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
9141 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
9142 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
9143 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
9144 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
9145 Changed = true;
9146 }
9147 break;
9148 }
9149 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
9150 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
9151 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
9152 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
9153 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9154 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00009155 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009156 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
9157 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
9158 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9159 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
9160 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
9161 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
9162 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
9163 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
9164 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
9165 Changed = true;
9166 }
9167 break;
9168 }
9169 }
9170
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009171 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
9172 // (x >s -1) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009173 CmpInst::Predicate Pred = CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009174 if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>()) &&
9175 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<0>()))
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009176 Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009177 else if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<0>()) &&
9178 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>()))
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009179 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
9180
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009181 if (Pred != CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE) {
9182 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
9183 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
9184 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
9185 const APInt &Op1CV = CI->getValue();
9186
9187 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
9188 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
9189 if ((Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009190 (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009191 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009192 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00009193 In->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits()-1);
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009194 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +00009195 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009196 *ICI);
Dan Gohman21440ac2008-11-02 00:17:33 +00009197 if (In->getType() != SI.getType())
9198 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, SI.getType(),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009199 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", ICI);
9200
9201 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009202 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009203 In->getName()+".not"), *ICI);
9204
9205 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, In);
9206 }
9207 }
9208 }
9209
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009210 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
9211 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
9212 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
9213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9214 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
9215 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
9216 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9217 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
9218
9219 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
9220 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
9221 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
9222 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9223 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
9224 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
9225 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9226 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
9227 }
9228
9229 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer ABS
9230
9231 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
9232}
9233
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00009234/// isDefinedInBB - Return true if the value is an instruction defined in the
9235/// specified basicblock.
9236static bool isDefinedInBB(const Value *V, const BasicBlock *BB) {
9237 const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
9238 return I != 0 && I->getParent() == BB;
9239}
9240
9241
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009242Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009243 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
9244 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
9245 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
9246
9247 // select true, X, Y -> X
9248 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009249 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009250 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009251
9252 // select C, X, X -> X
9253 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
9254 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9255
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009256 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
9257 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9258 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
9259 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9260 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
9261 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
9262 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9263 else
9264 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9265 }
9266
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009267 if (SI.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context)) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00009268 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009269 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009270 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009271 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009272 } else {
9273 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
9274 Value *NotCond =
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009275 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009276 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009277 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009278 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00009279 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009280 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009281 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009282 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009283 } else {
9284 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
9285 Value *NotCond =
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009286 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009287 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009288 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009289 }
9290 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00009291
9292 // select a, b, a -> a&b
9293 // select a, a, b -> a|b
9294 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009295 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00009296 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009297 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009298 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009299
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00009300 // Selecting between two integer constants?
9301 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
9302 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009303 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009304 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009305 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009306 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009307 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00009308 Value *NotCond =
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009309 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00009310 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009311 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00009312 }
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009313
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009314 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009315 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009316 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009317 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
9318 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009319 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00009320 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009321 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
9322 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
9323 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009324 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
9325 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
9326 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009327 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
9328 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009329 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
9330 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009331 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009332 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009333 Value *V = ICA;
9334 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009335 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009336 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
9337 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
9338 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009339 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009340 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009341
9342 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009343 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
9344 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009345 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009346 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
9347 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
9348 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
9349 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
9350 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
9351 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
9352 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
9353 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
9354 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009355 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009356 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009357 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009358 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009359 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009360 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009361
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009362 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009363 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009364 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
9365 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
9366 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
9367 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
9368 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
9369 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
9370 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
9371 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
9372 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
9373 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9374 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009375 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009376 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
9377 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009378 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009379 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009380 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009381 }
9382
9383 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009384 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
9385 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
9386 return Result;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009387
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009388 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
9389 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
9390 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009391 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
9392
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009393 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
9394 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
9395 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
9396 return IV;
9397
9398 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
9399 // even legal for FP.
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009400 if ((TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
9401 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) ||
9402 (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FSub &&
9403 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd)) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009404 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009405 } else if ((FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
9406 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) ||
9407 (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FSub &&
9408 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd)) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009409 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
9410 }
9411
9412 if (AddOp) {
9413 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
9414 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
9415 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
9416 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
9417 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
9418 }
9419
9420 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009421 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
9422 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
9423 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
9424 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00009425 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009426 } else {
9427 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009428 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00009429 "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009430 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009431
9432 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
9433 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
9434 if (AddOp != TI)
9435 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
9436 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009437 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
9438 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009439
9440 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009441 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009442 }
9443 }
9444 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009445
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009446 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00009447 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009448 Instruction *FoldI = FoldSelectIntoOp(SI, TrueVal, FalseVal);
9449 if (FoldI)
9450 return FoldI;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009451 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00009452
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00009453 // See if we can fold the select into a phi node. The true/false values have
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00009454 // to be live in the predecessor blocks. If they are instructions in SI's
9455 // block, we can't map to the predecessor.
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00009456 if (isa<PHINode>(SI.getCondition()) &&
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00009457 (!isDefinedInBB(SI.getTrueValue(), SI.getParent()) ||
9458 isa<PHINode>(SI.getTrueValue())) &&
9459 (!isDefinedInBB(SI.getFalseValue(), SI.getParent()) ||
9460 isa<PHINode>(SI.getFalseValue())))
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00009461 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(SI))
9462 return NV;
9463
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00009464 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
9465 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
9466 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
9467 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
9468 return &SI;
9469 }
9470
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009471 return 0;
9472}
9473
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009474/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
9475/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
9476/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
9477/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
9478/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
9479///
9480static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9481 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009482
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009483 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
9484 if (!U) return Align;
9485
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +00009486 switch (Operator::getOpcode(U)) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009487 default: break;
9488 case Instruction::BitCast:
9489 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
9490 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009491 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
9492 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00009493 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009494 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
9495 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009496 AllZeroOperands = false;
9497 break;
9498 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009499
9500 if (AllZeroOperands) {
9501 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009502 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009503 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009504 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009505 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009506 }
9507
9508 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
9509 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
9510 // of the global.
9511 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
Dan Gohmanecd0fb52009-02-16 23:02:21 +00009512 if (GV->getAlignment() >= PrefAlign)
9513 Align = GV->getAlignment();
9514 else {
9515 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
9516 Align = PrefAlign;
9517 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009518 }
Chris Lattner42ebefa2009-09-27 21:42:46 +00009519 } else if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(V)) {
9520 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up.
9521 if (AI->getAlignment() >= PrefAlign)
9522 Align = AI->getAlignment();
9523 else {
9524 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
9525 Align = PrefAlign;
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009526 }
9527 }
9528
9529 return Align;
9530}
9531
9532/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
9533/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
9534/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
9535/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
9536unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9537 unsigned PrefAlign) {
9538 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
9539 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
9540 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
9541 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
9542 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
9543 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
9544 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
9545
9546 if (PrefAlign > Align)
9547 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
9548
9549 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
9550 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009551}
9552
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009553Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009554 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohmanbc989d42009-02-22 18:06:32 +00009555 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009556 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009557 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment();
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009558
9559 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009560 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(MI->getAlignmentType(),
Owen Andersona547b472009-07-09 18:36:20 +00009561 MinAlign, false));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009562 return MI;
9563 }
9564
9565 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
9566 // load/store.
9567 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
9568 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
9569
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009570 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
9571 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
9572 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
9573 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009574 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009575 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
9576
9577 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009578 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009579
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009580 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009581 Type *NewPtrTy =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009582 PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(*Context, Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009583
9584 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
9585 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
9586 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
9587 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
9588 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
9589 // integer datatype.
9590 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
9591 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00009592 if (TD && SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009593 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
9594 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009595 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009596 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
9597 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
9598 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
9599 else
9600 break;
9601 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
9602 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
9603 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
9604 else
9605 break;
9606 } else
9607 break;
9608 }
9609
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009610 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +00009611 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009612 }
9613 }
9614
9615
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009616 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
9617 // infer, use it.
9618 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
9619 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
9620
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009621 Value *Src = Builder->CreateBitCast(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy);
9622 Value *Dest = Builder->CreateBitCast(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009623 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
9624 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
9625 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
9626
9627 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00009628 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009629 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009630}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009631
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009632Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
9633 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009634 if (MI->getAlignment() < Alignment) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009635 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(MI->getAlignmentType(),
Owen Andersona547b472009-07-09 18:36:20 +00009636 Alignment, false));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009637 return MI;
9638 }
9639
9640 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
9641 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
9642 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009643 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::getInt8Ty(*Context))
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009644 return 0;
9645 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009646 Alignment = MI->getAlignment();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009647
9648 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
9649 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
9650
9651 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
9652 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009653 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(*Context, Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009654
9655 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009656 Dest = Builder->CreateBitCast(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009657
9658 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
9659 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
9660
9661 // Extract the fill value and store.
9662 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009663 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009664 Dest, false, Alignment), *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009665
9666 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00009667 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009668 return MI;
9669 }
9670
9671 return 0;
9672}
9673
9674
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009675/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
9676/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
9677/// the heavy lifting.
9678///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009679Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattneraab6ec42009-05-13 17:39:14 +00009680 // If the caller function is nounwind, mark the call as nounwind, even if the
9681 // callee isn't.
9682 if (CI.getParent()->getParent()->doesNotThrow() &&
9683 !CI.doesNotThrow()) {
9684 CI.setDoesNotThrow();
9685 return &CI;
9686 }
9687
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009688 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
9689 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
9690
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009691 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
9692 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009693 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009694 bool Changed = false;
9695
9696 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
9697 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
9698 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9699
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009700 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009701 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009702 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
9703 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
9704 // alignment is sufficient.
9705 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009706 }
9707
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009708 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
9709 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
9710 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009711 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009712 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
9713 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
9714 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +00009715 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy;
9716 const Type *Tys[1];
9717 Tys[0] = CI.getOperand(3)->getType();
9718 CI.setOperand(0,
9719 Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID, Tys, 1));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009720 Changed = true;
9721 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00009722
9723 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
9724 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
9725 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009726 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009727
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009728 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
9729 // set, update the alignment.
Chris Lattner3ce5e882009-03-08 03:37:16 +00009730 if (isa<MemTransferInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009731 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
9732 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009733 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
9734 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
9735 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009736 }
9737
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009738 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009739 }
9740
9741 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
9742 default: break;
9743 case Intrinsic::bswap:
9744 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
9745 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
9746 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
9747 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
9748 break;
9749 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
9750 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
9751 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
9752 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
9753 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
9754 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9755 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9756 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009757 Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1),
9758 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009759 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009760 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009761 break;
9762 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
9763 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
9764 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9765 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
9766 const Type *OpPtrTy =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +00009767 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009768 Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009769 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
9770 }
9771 break;
9772 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
9773 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
9774 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009775 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9776 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9777 const Type *OpPtrTy =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +00009778 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009779 Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009780 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
9781 }
9782 break;
9783
9784 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
9785 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
9786 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00009787 unsigned VWidth =
9788 cast<VectorType>(II->getOperand(1)->getType())->getNumElements();
9789 APInt DemandedElts(VWidth, 1);
9790 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
9791 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009792 UndefElts)) {
9793 II->setOperand(1, V);
9794 return II;
9795 }
9796 break;
9797 }
9798
9799 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
9800 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
9801 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
9802 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009803
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009804 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
9805 bool AllEltsOk = true;
9806 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
9807 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
9808 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
9809 AllEltsOk = false;
9810 break;
9811 }
9812 }
9813
9814 if (AllEltsOk) {
9815 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009816 Value *Op0 = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType());
9817 Value *Op1 = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType());
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00009818 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009819
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009820 // Only extract each element once.
9821 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
9822 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
9823
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009824 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009825 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
9826 continue;
9827 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
9828 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
9829
9830 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009831 ExtractedElts[Idx] =
9832 Builder->CreateExtractElement(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1,
9833 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Idx&15, false),
9834 "tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009835 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009836
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009837 // Insert this value into the result vector.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009838 Result = Builder->CreateInsertElement(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
9839 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i, false),
9840 "tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009841 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009842 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009843 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009844 }
9845 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009846
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009847 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
9848 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
9849 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
9850 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
9851 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
9852 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
9853 if (&*++BI == II)
9854 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009855 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009856 }
9857
9858 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
9859 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
9860 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
9861 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
9862 bool CannotRemove = false;
9863 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00009864 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) || isMalloc(BI)) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009865 CannotRemove = true;
9866 break;
9867 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00009868 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
9869 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
9870 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
9871 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
9872 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9873 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
9874 } else {
9875 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
9876 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00009877 CannotRemove = true;
9878 break;
9879 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009880 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009881 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009882
9883 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
9884 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
9885 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
9886 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9887 break;
9888 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009889 }
9890
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009891 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009892}
9893
9894// InvokeInst simplification
9895//
9896Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009897 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009898}
9899
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00009900/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
9901/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009902static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
9903 const CastInst * const CI,
9904 const TargetData * const TD,
9905 const int ix) {
9906 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
9907 return false;
9908
9909 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
9910 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
9911 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009912 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009913 return true;
9914
9915 const Type* SrcTy =
9916 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
9917 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9918 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
9919 return false;
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00009920 if (!TD || TD->getTypeAllocSize(SrcTy) != TD->getTypeAllocSize(DstTy))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009921 return false;
9922 return true;
9923}
9924
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009925// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
9926//
9927Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009928 bool Changed = false;
9929
9930 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
9931 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009932 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
9933
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009934 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009935
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009936 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
9937 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
9938 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
9939 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
9940 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00009941 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
Duncan Sandsac53a0b2009-10-06 15:40:36 +00009942 UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(*Context)),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009943 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009944 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00009945 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009946 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
9947 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
9948 return 0;
9949 }
9950
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009951 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
9952 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
9953 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
9954 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00009955 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
Duncan Sandsac53a0b2009-10-06 15:40:36 +00009956 UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(*Context)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009957 CS.getInstruction());
9958
9959 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
9960 CS.getInstruction()->
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00009961 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009962
9963 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
9964 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009965 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00009966 ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009967 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009968 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
9969 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009970
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009971 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
9972 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
9973 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
9974 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
9975
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009976 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9977 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
9978 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00009979 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009980 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
9981 // the call.
9982 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009983 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
9984 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
9985 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
9986 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
9987 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009988 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009989 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009990 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009991
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009992 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009993 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009994 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009995 Changed = true;
9996 }
9997
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009998 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009999}
10000
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010001// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
10002// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
10003//
10004bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
10005 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
10006 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010007 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
10008 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010009 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +000010010 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010011 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010012 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010013
10014 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
10015 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
10016 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
10017 //
10018 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
10019 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010020 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010021
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010022 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +000010023 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
10024
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010025 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010026 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000010027 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010028 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
10029 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000010030 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || !TD ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010031 OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext())) &&
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000010032 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || !TD ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010033 NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext()))))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +000010034 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010035
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010036 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010037 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010038 NewRetTy != Type::getVoidTy(*Context) && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010039 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
10040
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010041 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010042 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010043 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +000010044 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
10045 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010046
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010047 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
10048 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
10049 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
10050 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
10051 if (!Caller->use_empty())
10052 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
10053 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
10054 UI != E; ++UI)
10055 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
10056 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +000010057 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010058 return false;
10059 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010060
10061 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
10062 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010063
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010064 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
10065 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
10066 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +000010067 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010068
10069 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010070 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
10071
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010072 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
10073 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010074 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010075
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010076 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
10077 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +000010078 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010079 (TD && ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) ||
10080 ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext())) &&
10081 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) ||
10082 ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext()))));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010083 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010084 }
10085
10086 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010087 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010088 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010089
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010090 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
10091 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010092 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010093 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
10094 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010095 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
10096 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010097 break;
Devang Pateleaf42ab2008-09-23 23:03:40 +000010098 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010099 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010100 return false;
10101 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010102
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010103 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
10104 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
10105 std::vector<Value*> Args;
10106 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010107 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010108 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
10109
10110 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010111 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010112
10113 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
10114 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010115 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010116
10117 // Add the new return attributes.
10118 if (RAttrs)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010119 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010120
10121 AI = CS.arg_begin();
10122 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
10123 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
10124 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
10125 Args.push_back(*AI);
10126 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +000010127 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010128 false, ParamTy, false);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010129 Args.push_back(Builder->CreateCast(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp"));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010130 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010131
10132 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010133 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010134 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010135 }
10136
10137 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010138 // now.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010139 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000010140 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010141
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010142 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010143 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010144 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Daniel Dunbarce63ffb2009-07-25 00:23:56 +000010145 errs() << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
10146 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010147 } else {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010148 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010149 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
10150 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
10151 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
10152 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010153 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
10154 CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false, PTy, false);
10155 Args.push_back(Builder->CreateCast(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp"));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010156 } else {
10157 Args.push_back(*AI);
10158 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010159
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010160 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010161 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010162 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010163 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010164 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010165 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010166
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010167 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
10168 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
10169
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010170 if (NewRetTy == Type::getVoidTy(*Context))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010171 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010172
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +000010173 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),
10174 attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010175
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010176 Instruction *NC;
10177 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010178 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010179 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
10180 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +000010181 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010182 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010183 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010184 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
10185 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +000010186 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
10187 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +000010188 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +000010189 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010190 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010191 }
10192
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010193 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010194 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010195 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010196 if (NV->getType() != Type::getVoidTy(*Context)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010197 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010198 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010199 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +000010200
10201 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
10202 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
10203 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000010204 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +000010205 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
10206 } else {
10207 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
10208 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
10209 }
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +000010210 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010211 } else {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000010212 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010213 }
10214 }
10215
Chris Lattner931f8f32009-08-31 05:17:58 +000010216
10217 if (!Caller->use_empty())
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010218 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattner931f8f32009-08-31 05:17:58 +000010219
10220 EraseInstFromFunction(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010221 return true;
10222}
10223
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010224// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
10225// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
10226//
10227Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
10228 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
10229 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
10230 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010231 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010232
10233 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
10234 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010235 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010236 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010237
10238 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
10239 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
10240
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +000010241 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010242 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
10243 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
10244
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010245 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010246 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010247 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
10248 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010249 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010250
10251 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
10252 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
10253 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010254 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010255 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
10256 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010257 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010258 break;
10259 }
10260
10261 if (NestTy) {
10262 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
10263 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
10264 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
10265
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010266 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010267 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010268
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010269 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010270 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
10271
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010272 // Add any result attributes.
10273 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010274 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010275
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010276 {
10277 unsigned Idx = 1;
10278 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
10279 do {
10280 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010281 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010282 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
10283 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
10284 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
10285 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010286 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010287 }
10288
10289 if (I == E)
10290 break;
10291
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010292 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010293 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010294 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010295 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010296 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010297
10298 ++Idx, ++I;
10299 } while (1);
10300 }
10301
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010302 // Add any function attributes.
10303 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
10304 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
10305
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010306 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
10307 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010308 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010309
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010310 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010311 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
10312
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010313 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010314 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010315 {
10316 unsigned Idx = 1;
10317 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
10318 E = FTy->param_end();
10319
10320 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010321 if (Idx == NestIdx)
10322 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010323 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010324
10325 if (I == E)
10326 break;
10327
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010328 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010329 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010330
10331 ++Idx, ++I;
10332 } while (1);
10333 }
10334
10335 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
10336 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000010337 FunctionType *NewFTy = FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010338 FTy->isVarArg());
10339 Constant *NewCallee =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000010340 NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000010341 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF,
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000010342 PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +000010343 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),
10344 NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010345
10346 Instruction *NewCaller;
10347 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010348 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
10349 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
10350 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
10351 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010352 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010353 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010354 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010355 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
10356 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010357 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
10358 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
10359 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
10360 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010361 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010362 }
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010363 if (Caller->getType() != Type::getVoidTy(*Context) && !Caller->use_empty())
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010364 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
10365 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000010366 Worklist.Remove(Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010367 return 0;
10368 }
10369 }
10370
10371 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
10372 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
10373 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
10374 Constant *NewCallee =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010375 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF :
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000010376 ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010377 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
10378 return CS.getInstruction();
10379}
10380
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010381/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(a,c)]
10382/// and if a/b/c and the add's all have a single use, turn this into a phi
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010383/// and a single binop.
10384Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10385 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010386 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010387 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010388 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10389 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
10390
10391 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
10392 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010393
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010394 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, and all have one use.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010395 for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010396 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +000010397 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010398 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010399 // types or GEP's with different index types.
10400 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
10401 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010402 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010403
10404 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
10405 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
10406 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
10407 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
10408 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010409
10410 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
10411 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
10412 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010413 }
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010414
10415 // If both LHS and RHS would need a PHI, don't do this transformation,
10416 // because it would increase the number of PHIs entering the block,
10417 // which leads to higher register pressure. This is especially
10418 // bad when the PHIs are in the header of a loop.
10419 if (!LHSVal && !RHSVal)
10420 return 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010421
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010422 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform!
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +000010423
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010424 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010425 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +000010426 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010427 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010428 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
10429 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010430 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
10431 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010432 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
10433 LHSVal = NewLHS;
10434 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010435
10436 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010437 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
10438 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010439 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
10440 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010441 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
10442 RHSVal = NewRHS;
10443 }
10444
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010445 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010446 if (NewLHS || NewRHS) {
10447 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10448 Instruction *InInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10449 if (NewLHS) {
10450 Value *NewInLHS = InInst->getOperand(0);
10451 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10452 }
10453 if (NewRHS) {
10454 Value *NewInRHS = InInst->getOperand(1);
10455 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10456 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010457 }
10458 }
10459
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010460 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010461 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010462 CmpInst *CIOp = cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +000010463 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +000010464 LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010465}
10466
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010467Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10468 GetElementPtrInst *FirstInst =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
10469
10470 SmallVector<Value*, 16> FixedOperands(FirstInst->op_begin(),
10471 FirstInst->op_end());
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010472 // This is true if all GEP bases are allocas and if all indices into them are
10473 // constants.
10474 bool AllBasePointersAreAllocas = true;
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000010475
10476 // We don't want to replace this phi if the replacement would require
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010477 // more than one phi, which leads to higher register pressure. This is
10478 // especially bad when the PHIs are in the header of a loop.
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000010479 bool NeededPhi = false;
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010480
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010481 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, and all have one use.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010482 for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
10483 GetElementPtrInst *GEP= dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10484 if (!GEP || !GEP->hasOneUse() || GEP->getType() != FirstInst->getType() ||
10485 GEP->getNumOperands() != FirstInst->getNumOperands())
10486 return 0;
10487
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010488 // Keep track of whether or not all GEPs are of alloca pointers.
10489 if (AllBasePointersAreAllocas &&
10490 (!isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) ||
10491 !GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()))
10492 AllBasePointersAreAllocas = false;
10493
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010494 // Compare the operand lists.
10495 for (unsigned op = 0, e = FirstInst->getNumOperands(); op != e; ++op) {
10496 if (FirstInst->getOperand(op) == GEP->getOperand(op))
10497 continue;
10498
10499 // Don't merge two GEPs when two operands differ (introducing phi nodes)
10500 // if one of the PHIs has a constant for the index. The index may be
10501 // substantially cheaper to compute for the constants, so making it a
10502 // variable index could pessimize the path. This also handles the case
10503 // for struct indices, which must always be constant.
10504 if (isa<ConstantInt>(FirstInst->getOperand(op)) ||
10505 isa<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(op)))
10506 return 0;
10507
10508 if (FirstInst->getOperand(op)->getType() !=GEP->getOperand(op)->getType())
10509 return 0;
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000010510
10511 // If we already needed a PHI for an earlier operand, and another operand
10512 // also requires a PHI, we'd be introducing more PHIs than we're
10513 // eliminating, which increases register pressure on entry to the PHI's
10514 // block.
10515 if (NeededPhi)
10516 return 0;
10517
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010518 FixedOperands[op] = 0; // Needs a PHI.
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000010519 NeededPhi = true;
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010520 }
10521 }
10522
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010523 // If all of the base pointers of the PHI'd GEPs are from allocas, don't
Chris Lattner21550882009-02-23 05:56:17 +000010524 // bother doing this transformation. At best, this will just save a bit of
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010525 // offset calculation, but all the predecessors will have to materialize the
10526 // stack address into a register anyway. We'd actually rather *clone* the
10527 // load up into the predecessors so that we have a load of a gep of an alloca,
10528 // which can usually all be folded into the load.
10529 if (AllBasePointersAreAllocas)
10530 return 0;
10531
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010532 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform. Insert PHI nodes for each operand
10533 // that is variable.
10534 SmallVector<PHINode*, 16> OperandPhis(FixedOperands.size());
10535
10536 bool HasAnyPHIs = false;
10537 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FixedOperands.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10538 if (FixedOperands[i]) continue; // operand doesn't need a phi.
10539 Value *FirstOp = FirstInst->getOperand(i);
10540 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstOp->getType(),
10541 FirstOp->getName()+".pn");
10542 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10543
10544 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(e);
10545 NewPN->addIncoming(FirstOp, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
10546 OperandPhis[i] = NewPN;
10547 FixedOperands[i] = NewPN;
10548 HasAnyPHIs = true;
10549 }
10550
10551
10552 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
10553 if (HasAnyPHIs) {
10554 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10555 GetElementPtrInst *InGEP =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10556 BasicBlock *InBB = PN.getIncomingBlock(i);
10557
10558 for (unsigned op = 0, e = OperandPhis.size(); op != e; ++op)
10559 if (PHINode *OpPhi = OperandPhis[op])
10560 OpPhi->addIncoming(InGEP->getOperand(op), InBB);
10561 }
10562 }
10563
10564 Value *Base = FixedOperands[0];
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000010565 return cast<GEPOperator>(FirstInst)->isInBounds() ?
10566 GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(Base, FixedOperands.begin()+1,
10567 FixedOperands.end()) :
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +000010568 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Base, FixedOperands.begin()+1,
10569 FixedOperands.end());
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010570}
10571
10572
Chris Lattner21550882009-02-23 05:56:17 +000010573/// isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe to
10574/// sink the load out of the block that defines it. This means that it must be
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010575/// obvious the value of the load is not changed from the point of the load to
10576/// the end of the block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010577///
10578/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
10579/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
10580/// to a register.
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010581static bool isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010582 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
10583
10584 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
10585 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
10586 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010587
10588 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
10589 // profitable to do this xform.
10590 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
10591 bool isAddressTaken = false;
10592 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
10593 UI != E; ++UI) {
10594 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
10595 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
10596 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
10597 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
10598 }
10599 isAddressTaken = true;
10600 break;
10601 }
10602
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010603 if (!isAddressTaken && AI->isStaticAlloca())
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010604 return false;
10605 }
10606
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010607 // If this load is a load from a GEP with a constant offset from an alloca,
10608 // then we don't want to sink it. In its present form, it will be
10609 // load [constant stack offset]. Sinking it will cause us to have to
10610 // materialize the stack addresses in each predecessor in a register only to
10611 // do a shared load from register in the successor.
10612 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(L->getOperand(0)))
10613 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)))
10614 if (AI->isStaticAlloca() && GEP->hasAllConstantIndices())
10615 return false;
10616
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010617 return true;
10618}
10619
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010620
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010621// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
10622// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
10623// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
10624Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10625 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
10626
10627 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
10628 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
10629 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
10630 // code size and simplifying code.
10631 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
10632 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010633 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010634 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
10635 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +000010636 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010637 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
10638 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010639 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010640 if (ConstantOp == 0)
10641 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010642 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
10643 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
10644 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
10645 // load and the PHI.
10646 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010647 !isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LI))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010648 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010649
10650 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10651 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10652 // the path through the other successor.
10653 if (isVolatile &&
10654 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10655 return 0;
10656
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010657 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010658 return FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010659 } else {
10660 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
10661 }
10662
10663 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
10664 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10665 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
10666 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010667 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010668 return 0;
10669 if (CastSrcTy) {
10670 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
10671 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010672 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010673 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
10674 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010675 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
10676 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010677 !isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LI))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010678 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010679
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010680 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10681 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10682 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010683 if (isVolatile &&
10684 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10685 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010686
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010687 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
10688 return 0;
10689 }
10690 }
10691
10692 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
10693 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010694 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
10695 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +000010696 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010697
10698 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10699 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010700
10701 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010702 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10703 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
10704 if (NewInVal != InVal)
10705 InVal = 0;
10706 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10707 }
10708
10709 Value *PhiVal;
10710 if (InVal) {
10711 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
10712 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
10713 PhiVal = InVal;
10714 delete NewPN;
10715 } else {
10716 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10717 PhiVal = NewPN;
10718 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010719
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010720 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010721 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010722 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010723 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010724 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010725 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +000010726 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010727 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010728 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
10729
10730 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
10731 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
10732 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
10733 if (isVolatile)
10734 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
10735 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
10736
10737 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010738}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010739
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010740/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
10741/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010742static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
10743 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010744 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
10745 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
10746
10747 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010748 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010749 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +000010750
10751 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10752 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
10753 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010754
10755 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
10756 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010757
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010758 return false;
10759}
10760
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010761/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
10762/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
10763/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10764static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
10765 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
10766 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
10767 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
10768 return true;
10769
10770 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10771 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
10772 return false;
10773
10774 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
10775 // the value.
10776 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10777 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
10778 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
10779 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10780 return false;
10781 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
10782 return false;
10783 }
10784
10785 return true;
10786}
10787
10788
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010789// PHINode simplification
10790//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010791Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +000010792 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010793 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +000010794
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010795 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
10796 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
10797
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010798 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
10799 // reducing code size.
10800 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010801 isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1)) &&
10802 cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0))->getOpcode() ==
10803 cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1))->getOpcode() &&
10804 // FIXME: The hasOneUse check will fail for PHIs that use the value more
10805 // than themselves more than once.
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010806 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
10807 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
10808 return Result;
10809
10810 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
10811 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
10812 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010813 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
10814 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
10815 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010816 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010817 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
10818 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000010819 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010820 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010821
10822 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
10823 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
10824 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
10825 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
10826 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
10827 // late.
10828 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
10829 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
10830 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000010831 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010832 }
10833 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010834
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010835 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
10836 // same value, for example:
10837 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10838 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
10839 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
10840 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
10841 {
10842 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
10843 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
10844 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
10845 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
10846 ++InValNo;
10847
10848 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
10849 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
10850
10851 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
10852 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
10853 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
10854 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
10855 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
10856 break;
10857 }
10858
10859 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
10860 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
10861 // the value.
10862 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
10863 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
10864 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10865 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
10866 }
10867 }
10868 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +000010869 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010870}
10871
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010872Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010873 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000010874 // Eliminate 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' and 'getelementptr %P', they are noops.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010875 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010876 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010877
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010878 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000010879 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010880
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010881 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
10882 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
10883 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
10884
10885 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010886 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010887
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010888 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010889 if (TD) {
10890 bool MadeChange = false;
10891 unsigned PtrSize = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
10892
10893 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
10894 for (User::op_iterator I = GEP.op_begin() + 1, E = GEP.op_end();
10895 I != E; ++I, ++GTI) {
10896 if (!isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) continue;
10897
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010898 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010899 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need. This
10900 // explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more obvious.
10901 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>((*I)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010902 if (OpBits == PtrSize)
10903 continue;
10904
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +000010905 *I = Builder->CreateIntCast(*I, TD->getIntPtrType(GEP.getContext()),true);
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010906 MadeChange = true;
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010907 }
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010908 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010909 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010910
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010911 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
10912 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
10913 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
10914 //
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +000010915 if (GEPOperator *Src = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010916 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
10917 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
10918 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
10919 //
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000010920 if (GetElementPtrInst *SrcGEP =
10921 dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src->getOperand(0)))
10922 if (SrcGEP->getNumOperands() == 2)
10923 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010924
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010925 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010926
10927 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
10928 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000010929 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*Src), E = gep_type_end(*Src);
10930 I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +000010931 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010932
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010933 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010934 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +000010935 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
10936 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
10937 //
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000010938 Value *Sum;
10939 Value *SO1 = Src->getOperand(Src->getNumOperands()-1);
10940 Value *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000010941 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010942 Sum = GO1;
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000010943 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010944 Sum = SO1;
10945 } else {
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000010946 // If they aren't the same type, then the input hasn't been processed
10947 // by the loop above yet (which canonicalizes sequential index types to
10948 // intptr_t). Just avoid transforming this until the input has been
10949 // normalized.
10950 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType())
10951 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010952 Sum = Builder->CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010953 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010954
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000010955 // Update the GEP in place if possible.
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000010956 if (Src->getNumOperands() == 2) {
10957 GEP.setOperand(0, Src->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010958 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
10959 return &GEP;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010960 }
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000010961 Indices.append(Src->op_begin()+1, Src->op_end()-1);
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010962 Indices.push_back(Sum);
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000010963 Indices.append(GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010964 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010965 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000010966 Src->getNumOperands() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010967 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000010968 Indices.append(Src->op_begin()+1, Src->op_end());
10969 Indices.append(GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010970 }
10971
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000010972 if (!Indices.empty())
10973 return (cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() &&
10974 Src->isInBounds()) ?
10975 GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(Src->getOperand(0), Indices.begin(),
10976 Indices.end(), GEP.getName()) :
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000010977 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src->getOperand(0), Indices.begin(),
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010978 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner6e24d832009-08-30 05:00:50 +000010979 }
10980
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000010981 // Handle gep(bitcast x) and gep(gep x, 0, 0, 0).
10982 if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner6e24d832009-08-30 05:00:50 +000010983 assert(isa<PointerType>(X->getType()) && "Must be cast from pointer");
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000010984
Chris Lattner2de23192009-08-30 20:38:21 +000010985 // If the input bitcast is actually "bitcast(bitcast(x))", then we don't
10986 // want to change the gep until the bitcasts are eliminated.
10987 if (getBitCastOperand(X)) {
10988 Worklist.AddValue(PtrOp);
10989 return 0;
10990 }
10991
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000010992 // Transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
10993 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
10994 //
10995 // Likewise, transform: GEP (bitcast i8* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
10996 // into : GEP i8* X, ...
10997 //
10998 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
Chris Lattner6e24d832009-08-30 05:00:50 +000010999 if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011000 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
11001 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011002 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
11003 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType())) {
11004 // GEP (bitcast i8* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ... ?
11005 if (CATy->getElementType() == XTy->getElementType()) {
11006 // -> GEP i8* X, ...
11007 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices(GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011008 return cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
11009 GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(X, Indices.begin(), Indices.end(),
11010 GEP.getName()) :
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +000011011 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Indices.begin(), Indices.end(),
11012 GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000011013 }
11014
11015 if (const ArrayType *XATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType())){
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011016 // GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ... ?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011017 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011018 // -> GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011019 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
11020 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
11021 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
11022 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
11023 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
11024 return &GEP;
11025 }
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011026 }
11027 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011028 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
11029 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011030 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
11031 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011032 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
11033 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011034 if (TD && isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011035 TD->getTypeAllocSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
11036 TD->getTypeAllocSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011037 Value *Idx[2];
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011038 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011039 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011040 Value *NewGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
11041 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()) :
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011042 Builder->CreateGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011043 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011044 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000011045 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011046
11047 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011048 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011049 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011050 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011051
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011052 if (TD && isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::getInt8Ty(*Context)) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011053 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011054 TD->getTypeAllocSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011055
11056 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
11057 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
11058 Value *NewIdx = 0;
11059 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
11060 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
11061 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000011062 Scale = ConstantInt::get(cast<IntegerType>(NewIdx->getType()), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011063 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000011064 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011065 Scale = CI;
11066 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
11067 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
11068 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +000011069 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
11070 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000011071 Scale = ConstantInt::get(cast<IntegerType>(Inst->getType()),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +000011072 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011073 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
11074 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
11075 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
11076 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
11077 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
11078 }
11079 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011080
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011081 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011082 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
11083 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
11084 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
Chris Lattner58b1ac72009-02-25 18:20:01 +000011085 if (ArrayEltSize && Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011086 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000011087 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011088 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011089 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Chris Lattner878daed2009-08-30 05:56:44 +000011090 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
11091 false /*ZExt*/);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011092 NewIdx = Builder->CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011093 }
11094
11095 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011096 Value *Idx[2];
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011097 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011098 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011099 Value *NewGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
11100 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()) :
11101 Builder->CreateGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011102 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
11103 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011104 }
11105 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000011106 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011107 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011108
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011109 /// See if we can simplify:
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000011110 /// X = bitcast A* to B*
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011111 /// Y = gep X, <...constant indices...>
11112 /// into a gep of the original struct. This is important for SROA and alias
11113 /// analysis of unions. If "A" is also a bitcast, wait for A/X to be merged.
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011114 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(PtrOp)) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011115 if (TD &&
11116 !isa<BitCastInst>(BCI->getOperand(0)) && GEP.hasAllConstantIndices()) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011117 // Determine how much the GEP moves the pointer. We are guaranteed to get
11118 // a constant back from EmitGEPOffset.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011119 ConstantInt *OffsetV =
11120 cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(&GEP, GEP, *this));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011121 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
11122
11123 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, just replace the GEP
11124 // with a bitcast of the real input to the dest type.
11125 if (Offset == 0) {
11126 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
11127 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +000011128 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0)) ||
11129 isMalloc(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011130 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
11131 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
11132 if (I != BCI) {
11133 I->takeName(BCI);
11134 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
11135 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
11136 }
11137 return &GEP;
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011138 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011139 }
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011140 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011141 }
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011142
11143 // Otherwise, if the offset is non-zero, we need to find out if there is a
11144 // field at Offset in 'A's type. If so, we can pull the cast through the
11145 // GEP.
11146 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
11147 const Type *InTy =
11148 cast<PointerType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011149 if (FindElementAtOffset(InTy, Offset, NewIndices, TD, Context)) {
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011150 Value *NGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
11151 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(BCI->getOperand(0), NewIndices.begin(),
11152 NewIndices.end()) :
11153 Builder->CreateGEP(BCI->getOperand(0), NewIndices.begin(),
11154 NewIndices.end());
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011155
11156 if (NGEP->getType() == GEP.getType())
11157 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, NGEP);
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011158 NGEP->takeName(&GEP);
11159 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, GEP.getType());
11160 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011161 }
11162 }
11163
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011164 return 0;
11165}
11166
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011167Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
11168 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011169 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011170 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
11171 const Type *NewTy =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000011172 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000011173 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011174
11175 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
11176 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011177 New = Builder->CreateMalloc(NewTy, 0, AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000011178 else {
11179 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011180 New = Builder->CreateAlloca(NewTy, 0, AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000011181 }
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011182 New->setAlignment(AI.getAlignment());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011183
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011184 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
Dale Johannesena8915182009-03-11 22:19:43 +000011185 // allocas if possible...also skip interleaved debug info
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011186 //
11187 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
Dale Johannesena8915182009-03-11 22:19:43 +000011188 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It) || isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(*It)) ++It;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011189
11190 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
11191 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
11192 //
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011193 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011194 Value *Idx[2];
11195 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
11196 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011197 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
11198 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011199
11200 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
11201 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011202 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011203 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011204 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011205 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011206 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011207
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011208 if (TD && isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized()) {
Dan Gohman6893cd72009-01-13 20:18:38 +000011209 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
Chris Lattner46d232d2009-03-17 17:55:15 +000011210 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate
11211 // and return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011212 if (TD->getTypeAllocSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Dan Gohman6893cd72009-01-13 20:18:38 +000011214
11215 // If the alignment is 0 (unspecified), assign it the preferred alignment.
11216 if (AI.getAlignment() == 0)
11217 AI.setAlignment(TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI.getAllocatedType()));
11218 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011219
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011220 return 0;
11221}
11222
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000011223Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
11224 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
11225
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011226 // free undef -> unreachable.
11227 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
11228 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +000011229 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
Duncan Sandsac53a0b2009-10-06 15:40:36 +000011230 UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(*Context)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011231 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11232 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000011233
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000011234 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
11235 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011236 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011237 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000011238
11239 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
11240 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
11241 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
11242 return &FI;
11243 }
11244
11245 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
11246 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
11247 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011248 Worklist.Add(GEPI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000011249 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
11250 return &FI;
11251 }
11252 }
11253
11254 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
11255 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
11256 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
11257 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11258 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
11259 }
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +000011260 if (isMalloc(Op)) {
11261 if (CallInst* CI = extractMallocCallFromBitCast(Op)) {
11262 if (Op->hasOneUse() && CI->hasOneUse()) {
11263 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11264 EraseInstFromFunction(*CI);
11265 return EraseInstFromFunction(*cast<Instruction>(Op));
11266 }
11267 } else {
11268 // Op is a call to malloc
11269 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
11270 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11271 return EraseInstFromFunction(*cast<Instruction>(Op));
11272 }
11273 }
11274 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000011275
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000011276 return 0;
11277}
11278
11279
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011280/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011281static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000011282 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011283 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011284 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000011285 LLVMContext *Context = IC.getContext();
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011286
Nick Lewycky48f95ad2009-05-08 06:47:37 +000011287 if (TD) {
11288 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
11289 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
11290 // directly if string length is small enough.
11291 std::string Str;
11292 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
11293 unsigned len = Str.length();
11294 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
11295 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
11296 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
11297 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
11298 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
11299 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
11300 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
11301 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
11302 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i] & UCHAR_MAX;
11303 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
11304 }
11305 } else {
11306 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
11307 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i] & UCHAR_MAX;
11308 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
11309 }
11310 // Append NULL at the end.
11311 SingleChar = 0;
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000011312 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
11313 }
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000011314 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(*Context, StrVal);
Nick Lewycky48f95ad2009-05-08 06:47:37 +000011315 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000011316 }
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011317 }
11318 }
11319 }
11320
Mon P Wang6753f952009-02-07 22:19:29 +000011321 const PointerType *DestTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType());
11322 const Type *DestPTy = DestTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011323 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Mon P Wang6753f952009-02-07 22:19:29 +000011324
11325 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the cast.
11326 if (DestTy->getAddressSpace() != SrcTy->getAddressSpace())
11327 return 0;
11328
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011329 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011330
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000011331 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011332 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011333 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
11334 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
11335 // constants.
11336 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
11337 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
11338 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000011339 Value *Idxs[2];
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011340 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000011341 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011342 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
11343 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
11344 }
11345
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011346 if (IC.getTargetData() &&
11347 (SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011348 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000011349 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
11350 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
11351 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011352 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
11353 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011354
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011355 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
11356 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
11357 // the result of the loaded value.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011358 Value *NewLoad =
11359 IC.Builder->CreateLoad(CastOp, LI.isVolatile(), CI->getName());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011360 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000011361 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011362 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011363 }
11364 }
11365 return 0;
11366}
11367
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011368Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
11369 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000011370
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011371 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011372 if (TD) {
11373 unsigned KnownAlign =
11374 GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op, TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(LI.getType()));
11375 if (KnownAlign >
11376 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
11377 LI.getAlignment()))
11378 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
11379 }
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011380
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000011381 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011382 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011383 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011384 return Res;
11385
11386 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
11387 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000011388
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011389 // Do really simple store-to-load forwarding and load CSE, to catch cases
11390 // where there are several consequtive memory accesses to the same location,
11391 // separated by a few arithmetic operations.
11392 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI;
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011393 if (Value *AvailableVal = FindAvailableLoadedValue(Op, LI.getParent(), BBI,6))
11394 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, AvailableVal);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011395
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000011396 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
11397 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
11398 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
Chris Lattner8a67ac52009-08-30 20:06:40 +000011399 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) && GEPI->getPointerAddressSpace() == 0){
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011400 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
11401 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
11402 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
11403 // CFG.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011404 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011405 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011406 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011407 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000011408 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011409
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011410 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011411 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000011412 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
Chris Lattner8a67ac52009-08-30 20:06:40 +000011413 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) ||
11414 (C->isNullValue() && LI.getPointerAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011415 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
11416 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
11417 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011418 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011419 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011420 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011421 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011422
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011423 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
11424 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Duncan Sands64da9402009-03-21 21:27:31 +000011425 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011426 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011427
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011428 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011429 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011430 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
11431 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Duncan Sands64da9402009-03-21 21:27:31 +000011432 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000011433 if (Constant *V =
Dan Gohmanc6f69e92009-10-05 16:36:26 +000011434 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011435 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011436 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
11437 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
11438 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
11439 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
11440 // CFG.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011441 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011442 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011443 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011444 }
11445
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011446 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011447 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011448 return Res;
11449 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011450 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011451 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011452
11453 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
11454 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
Duncan Sands5d0392c2008-10-01 15:25:41 +000011455 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op->getUnderlyingObject())){
Duncan Sands64da9402009-03-21 21:27:31 +000011456 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer()) {
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011457 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011458 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011459 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011460 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011461 }
11462 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000011463
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011464 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011465 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
11466 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
11467 // exposes redundancy in the code.
11468 //
11469 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
11470 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
11471 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
11472 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
11473 // unconditionally.
11474 //
11475 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
11476 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000011477 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
11478 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011479 Value *V1 = Builder->CreateLoad(SI->getOperand(1),
11480 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val");
11481 Value *V2 = Builder->CreateLoad(SI->getOperand(2),
11482 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val");
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011483 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011484 }
11485
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000011486 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
11487 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
11488 if (C->isNullValue()) {
11489 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
11490 return &LI;
11491 }
11492
11493 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
11494 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
11495 if (C->isNullValue()) {
11496 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
11497 return &LI;
11498 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011499 }
11500 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011501 return 0;
11502}
11503
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000011504/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011505/// when possible. This makes it generally easy to do alias analysis and/or
11506/// SROA/mem2reg of the memory object.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011507static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
11508 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
11509 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
11510
11511 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011512 const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
11513 if (SrcTy == 0) return 0;
11514
11515 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011516
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011517 if (!DestPTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(DestPTy))
11518 return 0;
11519
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011520 /// NewGEPIndices - If SrcPTy is an aggregate type, we can emit a "noop gep"
11521 /// to its first element. This allows us to handle things like:
11522 /// store i32 xxx, (bitcast {foo*, float}* %P to i32*)
11523 /// on 32-bit hosts.
11524 SmallVector<Value*, 4> NewGEPIndices;
11525
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011526 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
11527 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
11528 // constants.
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011529 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcPTy) || isa<StructType>(SrcPTy)) {
11530 // Index through pointer.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011531 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*IC.getContext()));
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011532 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11533
11534 while (1) {
11535 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcPTy)) {
Torok Edwin08ffee52009-01-24 17:16:04 +000011536 if (!STy->getNumElements()) /* Struct can be empty {} */
Torok Edwin629e92b2009-01-24 11:30:49 +000011537 break;
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011538 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11539 SrcPTy = STy->getElementType(0);
11540 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy)) {
11541 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11542 SrcPTy = ATy->getElementType();
11543 } else {
11544 break;
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011545 }
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011546 }
11547
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000011548 SrcTy = PointerType::get(SrcPTy, SrcTy->getAddressSpace());
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011549 }
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011550
11551 if (!SrcPTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy))
11552 return 0;
11553
Chris Lattner71759c42009-01-16 20:12:52 +000011554 // If the pointers point into different address spaces or if they point to
11555 // values with different sizes, we can't do the transformation.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011556 if (!IC.getTargetData() ||
11557 SrcTy->getAddressSpace() !=
Chris Lattner71759c42009-01-16 20:12:52 +000011558 cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getAddressSpace() ||
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011559 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) !=
11560 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy))
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011561 return 0;
11562
11563 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
11564 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
11565 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
11566 Value *NewCast;
11567 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
11568 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
11569 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
11570 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
11571 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
11572 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
11573 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
11574 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
11575 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
11576 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011577 }
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011578
11579 // SIOp0 is a pointer to aggregate and this is a store to the first field,
11580 // emit a GEP to index into its first field.
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011581 if (!NewGEPIndices.empty())
11582 CastOp = IC.Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(CastOp, NewGEPIndices.begin(),
11583 NewGEPIndices.end());
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011584
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011585 NewCast = IC.Builder->CreateCast(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy,
11586 SIOp0->getName()+".c");
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011587 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011588}
11589
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011590/// equivalentAddressValues - Test if A and B will obviously have the same
11591/// value. This includes recognizing that %t0 and %t1 will have the same
11592/// value in code like this:
Dan Gohman0f8b53f2009-03-03 02:55:14 +000011593/// %t0 = getelementptr \@a, 0, 3
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011594/// store i32 0, i32* %t0
Dan Gohman0f8b53f2009-03-03 02:55:14 +000011595/// %t1 = getelementptr \@a, 0, 3
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011596/// %t2 = load i32* %t1
11597///
11598static bool equivalentAddressValues(Value *A, Value *B) {
11599 // Test if the values are trivially equivalent.
11600 if (A == B) return true;
11601
11602 // Test if the values come form identical arithmetic instructions.
Dan Gohman58cfa3b2009-08-25 22:11:20 +000011603 // This uses isIdenticalToWhenDefined instead of isIdenticalTo because
11604 // its only used to compare two uses within the same basic block, which
11605 // means that they'll always either have the same value or one of them
11606 // will have an undefined value.
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011607 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) ||
11608 isa<CastInst>(A) ||
11609 isa<PHINode>(A) ||
11610 isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A))
11611 if (Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(B))
Dan Gohman58cfa3b2009-08-25 22:11:20 +000011612 if (cast<Instruction>(A)->isIdenticalToWhenDefined(BI))
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011613 return true;
11614
11615 // Otherwise they may not be equivalent.
11616 return false;
11617}
11618
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011619// If this instruction has two uses, one of which is a llvm.dbg.declare,
11620// return the llvm.dbg.declare.
11621DbgDeclareInst *InstCombiner::hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Value *V) {
11622 if (!V->hasNUses(2))
11623 return 0;
11624 for (Value::use_iterator UI = V->use_begin(), E = V->use_end();
11625 UI != E; ++UI) {
11626 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = dyn_cast<DbgDeclareInst>(UI))
11627 return DI;
11628 if (isa<BitCastInst>(UI) && UI->hasOneUse()) {
11629 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = dyn_cast<DbgDeclareInst>(UI->use_begin()))
11630 return DI;
11631 }
11632 }
11633 return 0;
11634}
11635
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011636Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
11637 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
11638 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
11639
11640 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011641 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011642 ++NumCombined;
11643 return 0;
11644 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011645
11646 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
11647 // alloca dead.
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011648 // If the RHS is an alloca with a two uses, the other one being a
11649 // llvm.dbg.declare, zapify the store and the declare, making the
11650 // alloca dead. We must do this to prevent declare's from affecting
11651 // codegen.
11652 if (!SI.isVolatile()) {
11653 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
11654 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011655 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11656 ++NumCombined;
11657 return 0;
11658 }
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011659 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
11660 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
11661 if (GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
11662 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11663 ++NumCombined;
11664 return 0;
11665 }
11666 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
11667 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
11668 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11669 ++NumCombined;
11670 return 0;
11671 }
11672 }
11673 }
11674 }
11675 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Ptr)) {
11676 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
11677 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11678 ++NumCombined;
11679 return 0;
11680 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011681 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011682
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011683 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011684 if (TD) {
11685 unsigned KnownAlign =
11686 GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr, TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(Val->getType()));
11687 if (KnownAlign >
11688 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
11689 SI.getAlignment()))
11690 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
11691 }
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011692
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011693 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consecutive
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011694 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
11695 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
11696 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
11697 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
11698 --ScanInsts) {
Dale Johannesen0d6596b2009-03-04 01:20:34 +000011699 --BBI;
Dale Johannesencdb16aa2009-03-04 01:53:05 +000011700 // Don't count debug info directives, lest they affect codegen,
11701 // and we skip pointer-to-pointer bitcasts, which are NOPs.
11702 // It is necessary for correctness to skip those that feed into a
11703 // llvm.dbg.declare, as these are not present when debugging is off.
Dale Johannesen4ded40a2009-03-03 22:36:47 +000011704 if (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
Dale Johannesencdb16aa2009-03-04 01:53:05 +000011705 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType()))) {
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011706 ScanInsts++;
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011707 continue;
11708 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011709
11710 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
11711 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011712 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() &&equivalentAddressValues(PrevSI->getOperand(1),
11713 SI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011714 ++NumDeadStore;
11715 ++BBI;
11716 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
11717 continue;
11718 }
11719 break;
11720 }
11721
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011722 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
11723 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
11724 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
11725 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011726 if (LI == Val && equivalentAddressValues(LI->getOperand(0), Ptr) &&
11727 !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011728 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11729 ++NumCombined;
11730 return 0;
11731 }
11732 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
11733 // may not be dead.
11734 break;
11735 }
11736
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011737 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000011738 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011739 break;
11740 }
11741
11742
11743 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011744
11745 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
Chris Lattner8a67ac52009-08-30 20:06:40 +000011746 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr) && SI.getPointerAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011747 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011748 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011749 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011750 Worklist.Add(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011751 ++NumCombined;
11752 }
11753 return 0; // Do not modify these!
11754 }
11755
11756 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
11757 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011758 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011759 ++NumCombined;
11760 return 0;
11761 }
11762
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011763 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
11764 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011765 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011766 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11767 return Res;
11768 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011769 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011770 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11771 return Res;
11772
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011773
Dale Johannesen4084c4e2009-03-05 02:06:48 +000011774 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block (possibly
11775 // excepting debug info instructions and the pointer bitcasts that feed
11776 // into them), and if the block ends with an unconditional branch, try
11777 // to move it to the successor block.
11778 BBI = &SI;
11779 do {
11780 ++BBI;
11781 } while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
11782 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType())));
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011783 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011784 if (BI->isUnconditional())
11785 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
11786 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011787
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011788 return 0;
11789}
11790
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011791/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
11792/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
11793/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11794///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011795/// Simplify things like:
11796/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
11797/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11798///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011799bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
11800 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
11801
11802 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
11803 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
11804 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011805 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011806
11807 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
11808 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011809 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
11810 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011811 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011812 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011813 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011814 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011815 return false;
11816
11817 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011818 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011819 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011820 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011821 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011822 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011823 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000011824
11825 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
11826 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
11827 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
11828 return false;
11829
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011830 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
11831 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011832 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011833 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011834 return false;
11835
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011836 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
11837 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
11838 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
11839 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011840 --BBI;
Dale Johannesen4084c4e2009-03-05 02:06:48 +000011841 // Skip over debugging info.
11842 while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
11843 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType()))) {
11844 if (BBI==OtherBB->begin())
11845 return false;
11846 --BBI;
11847 }
11848 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011849 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
11850 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11851 return false;
11852 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011853 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011854 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
11855 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
11856 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
11857 return false;
11858
11859 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011860 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
11861 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011862 for (;; --BBI) {
11863 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
11864 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
11865 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11866 return false;
11867 break;
11868 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011869 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
11870 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
11871 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011872 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
11873 return false;
11874 }
11875
11876 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011877 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
11878 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011879 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
11880 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011881 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011882 return false;
11883 }
11884 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011885
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011886 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011887 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
11888 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011889 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011890 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
11891 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011892 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
11893 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011894 }
11895
11896 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
11897 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011898 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011899 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
11900 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
11901
11902 // Nuke the old stores.
11903 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11904 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
11905 ++NumCombined;
11906 return true;
11907}
11908
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011909
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011910Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
11911 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000011912 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011913 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
11914 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +000011915 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011916 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
11917 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11918 BI.setCondition(X);
11919 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11920 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
11921 return &BI;
11922 }
11923
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011924 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
11925 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
11926 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011927 TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
11928 BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse())
11929 if (FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
11930 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) {
11931 FCmpInst *Cond = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
11932 Cond->setPredicate(FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred));
11933
11934 // Swap Destinations and condition.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011935 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11936 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011937 Worklist.Add(Cond);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011938 return &BI;
11939 }
11940
11941 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
11942 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
11943 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011944 TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
11945 BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse())
11946 if (IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
11947 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
11948 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) {
11949 ICmpInst *Cond = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
11950 Cond->setPredicate(ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred));
11951 // Swap Destinations and condition.
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011952 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11953 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011954 Worklist.Add(Cond);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011955 return &BI;
11956 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011957
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011958 return 0;
11959}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011960
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011961Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
11962 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
11963 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
11964 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
11965 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
11966 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
11967 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011968 SI.setOperand(i,
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000011969 ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011970 AddRHS));
11971 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011972 Worklist.Add(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011973 return &SI;
11974 }
11975 }
11976 return 0;
11977}
11978
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011979Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011980 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011981
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011982 if (!EV.hasIndices())
11983 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
11984
11985 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
11986 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011987 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011988
11989 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011990 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011991
11992 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
11993 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
11994 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
11995 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
11996 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
11997 // first index
11998 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
11999 else
12000 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
12001 }
12002 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
12003 }
12004 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
12005 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
12006 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
12007 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
12008 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
12009 exti != exte && insi != inse;
12010 ++exti, ++insi) {
12011 if (*insi != *exti)
12012 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
12013 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
12014 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
12015 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
12016 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
12017 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
12018 // with
12019 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
12020 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
12021 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
12022 }
12023 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
12024 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
12025 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
12026 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
12027 // with "i32 42"
12028 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
12029 if (exti == exte) {
12030 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
12031 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
12032 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
12033 // with
12034 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
12035 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
12036 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
12037 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000012038 Value *NewEV = Builder->CreateExtractValue(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
12039 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012040 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
12041 insi, inse);
12042 }
12043 if (insi == inse)
12044 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
12045 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
12046 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
12047 // i.e., replace
12048 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
12049 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
12050 // with
12051 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
12052 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
12053 exti, exte);
12054 }
12055 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
12056 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
12057 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
12058 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000012059 return 0;
12060}
12061
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012062/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
12063/// is to leave as a vector operation.
12064static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
12065 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
12066 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012067 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012068 if (isConstant) return true;
12069 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
12070 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
12071 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
12072 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
12073 return false;
12074 return true;
12075 }
12076 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
12077 if (!I) return false;
12078
12079 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
12080 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
12081 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
12082 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
12083 return true;
12084 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
12085 return true;
12086 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
12087 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
12088 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
12089 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
12090 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012091 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
12092 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
12093 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
12094 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
12095 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012096
12097 return false;
12098}
12099
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000012100/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
12101///
12102/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
12103/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012104static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
12105 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
12106 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
12107 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
12108 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
12109 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
12110
12111 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012112 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000012113 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
12114 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012115 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
12116 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000012117 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012118 return Result;
12119}
12120
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012121/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
12122/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
12123/// extracted from the vector.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012124static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012125 LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012126 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
12127 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012128 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
12129 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012130 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012131
12132 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012133 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012134 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000012135 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012136 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012137 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
12138 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12139 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012140 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
12141 return 0;
12142 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012143
12144 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
12145 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012146 if (EltNo == IIElt)
12147 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012148
12149 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
12150 // vector input.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012151 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo, Context);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012152 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012153 unsigned LHSWidth =
12154 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012155 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012156 if (InEl < LHSWidth)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012157 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl, Context);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012158 else if (InEl < LHSWidth*2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012159 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - LHSWidth, Context);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012160 else
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012161 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012162 }
12163
12164 // Otherwise, we don't know.
12165 return 0;
12166}
12167
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012168Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000012169 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012170 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012171 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012172
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000012173 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012174 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000012175 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012176
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012177 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000012178 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
12179 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
12180 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012181 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner4cb81bd2009-09-08 03:44:51 +000012182 for (unsigned i = 1; i != C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012183 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
12184 op0 = 0;
12185 break;
12186 }
12187 if (op0)
12188 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012189 }
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012190
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012191 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
12192 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012193 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012194 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner4cb81bd2009-09-08 03:44:51 +000012195 unsigned VectorWidth = EI.getVectorOperandType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012196
12197 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
12198 // crashing the code below.
12199 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012200 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012201
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012202 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
12203 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
12204 // property.
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012205 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012206 APInt UndefElts(VectorWidth, 0);
12207 APInt DemandedMask(VectorWidth, 1 << IndexVal);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012208 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012209 DemandedMask, UndefElts)) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012210 EI.setOperand(0, V);
12211 return &EI;
12212 }
12213 }
12214
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012215 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal, Context))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012216 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000012217
12218 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
12219 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
12220 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
12221 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
12222 if (const VectorType *VT =
12223 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
12224 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012225 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0),
12226 IndexVal, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000012227 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
12228 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012229 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012230
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012231 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner275a6d62009-09-08 18:48:01 +000012232 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
12233 // profitable to do so
12234 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
12235 if (I->hasOneUse() &&
12236 CheapToScalarize(BO, isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1)))) {
12237 Value *newEI0 =
12238 Builder->CreateExtractElement(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
12239 EI.getName()+".lhs");
12240 Value *newEI1 =
12241 Builder->CreateExtractElement(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
12242 EI.getName()+".rhs");
12243 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012244 }
Chris Lattner275a6d62009-09-08 18:48:01 +000012245 } else if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012246 // Extracting the inserted element?
12247 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
12248 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
12249 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
12250 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +000012251 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) && isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +000012252 Worklist.AddValue(EI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012253 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
12254 return &EI;
12255 }
12256 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
12257 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
12258 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012259 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
12260 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012261 Value *Src;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012262 unsigned LHSWidth =
12263 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
12264
12265 if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth)
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012266 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012267 else if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth*2) {
12268 SrcIdx -= LHSWidth;
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012269 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
12270 } else {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012271 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000012272 }
Eric Christophera3500da2009-07-25 02:28:41 +000012273 return ExtractElementInst::Create(Src,
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +000012274 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), SrcIdx,
12275 false));
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012276 }
12277 }
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +000012278 // FIXME: Canonicalize extractelement(bitcast) -> bitcast(extractelement)
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012279 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012280 return 0;
12281}
12282
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012283/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
12284/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
12285/// Otherwise, return false.
12286static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012287 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012288 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012289 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
12290 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012291 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012292
12293 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012294 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012295 return true;
12296 } else if (V == LHS) {
12297 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012298 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012299 return true;
12300 } else if (V == RHS) {
12301 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012302 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012303 return true;
12304 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12305 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
12306 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
12307 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
12308 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
12309
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012310 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
12311 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012312 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012313
12314 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
12315 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
12316 // transitively ok.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012317 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask, Context)) {
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012318 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012319 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012320 return true;
12321 }
12322 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
12323 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012324 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
12325 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012326 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012327
12328 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
12329 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
12330 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
12331 // transitively ok.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012332 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask, Context)) {
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012333 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
12334 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012335 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012336 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012337 } else {
12338 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012339 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012340 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012341
12342 }
12343 return true;
12344 }
12345 }
12346 }
12347 }
12348 }
12349 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
12350
12351 return false;
12352}
12353
12354/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
12355/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
12356/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012357static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012358 Value *&RHS, LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012359 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012360 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012361 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012362 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012363
12364 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012365 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012366 return V;
12367 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012368 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012369 return V;
12370 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12371 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
12372 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
12373 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
12374 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
12375
12376 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
12377 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
12378 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
12379 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012380 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
12381 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012382
12383 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
12384 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012385 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
12386 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012387 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS, Context);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012388 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012389 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012390 return V;
12391 }
12392
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012393 if (VecOp == RHS) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012394 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask,
12395 RHS, Context);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012396 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
12397 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
12398 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012399 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012400 }
12401 return V;
12402 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012403
12404 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
12405 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012406 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask,
12407 Context))
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012408 return EI->getOperand(0);
12409
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012410 }
12411 }
12412 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012413 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012414
12415 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
12416 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012417 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012418 return V;
12419}
12420
12421Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
12422 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
12423 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
12424 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
12425
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000012426 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
12427 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
12428 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012429
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012430 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
12431 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
12432 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
12433 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
12434 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012435 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000012436 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
12437 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012438 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012439
12440 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
12441 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
12442
12443 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012444 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012445
12446 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
12447 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
12448 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
12449 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
12450
12451 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
12452 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
12453 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
12454 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
12455 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
12456 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
12457 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
12458 // Build a new shuffle mask.
12459 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
12460 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012461 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012462 else {
12463 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012464 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context),
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012465 NumVectorElts));
12466 }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012467 Mask[InsertedIdx] =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012468 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012469 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +000012470 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012471 }
12472
12473 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
12474 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
12475 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
12476 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012477 Value *RHS = 0;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012478 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS, Context);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012479 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012480 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012481 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS,
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +000012482 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012483 }
12484 }
12485 }
12486
Eli Friedmanb9a4cac2009-06-06 20:08:03 +000012487 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(VecOp->getType())->getNumElements();
12488 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
12489 APInt AllOnesEltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
12490 if (SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&IE, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts))
12491 return &IE;
12492
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012493 return 0;
12494}
12495
12496
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012497Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
12498 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12499 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012500 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012501
12502 bool MadeChange = false;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012503
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012504 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012505 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012506 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012507
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012508 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012509
12510 if (VWidth != cast<VectorType>(LHS->getType())->getNumElements())
12511 return 0;
12512
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012513 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
12514 APInt AllOnesEltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
12515 if (SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000012516 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12517 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012518 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000012519 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012520
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012521 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
12522 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
12523 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
12524 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012525 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
12526 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
12527 }
12528
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012529 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
12530 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
12531 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012532 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012533 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012534 else {
12535 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012536 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012537 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012538 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012539 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012540 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012541 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Mask[i]));
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012542 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012543 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012544 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012545 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012546 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +000012547 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012548 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12549 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012550 MadeChange = true;
12551 }
12552
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012553 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012554 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000012555
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012556 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
12557 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
12558 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
12559 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
12560
12561 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
12562 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000012563 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012564
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012565 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
12566 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
12567 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012568
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012569 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
12570 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
12571 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
12572 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
12573 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
12574 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
12575 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
12576 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
12577 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
12578 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
12579 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
12580 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
12581
12582 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
12583 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
12584 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
12585 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
12586 else
12587 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
12588
12589 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
12590 // the replacement.
12591 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
Mon P Wangfe6d2cd2009-01-26 04:39:00 +000012592 unsigned LHSInNElts =
12593 cast<VectorType>(LHSSVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012594 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
12595 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Mon P Wangfe6d2cd2009-01-26 04:39:00 +000012596 if (NewMask[i] >= LHSInNElts*2) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012597 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012598 } else {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012599 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012600 }
12601 }
12602 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
12603 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +000012604 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012605 }
12606 }
12607 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000012608
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012609 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
12610}
12611
12612
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012613
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012614
12615/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
12616/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
12617/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
12618/// end of its block.
12619static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
12620 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
12621
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000012622 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Duncan Sands7af1c782009-05-06 06:49:50 +000012623 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayHaveSideEffects() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000012624 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012625
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012626 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000012627 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
12628 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012629 return false;
12630
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012631 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
12632 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000012633 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
12634 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012635 Scan != E; ++Scan)
12636 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
12637 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012638 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012639
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000012640 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012641
Dale Johannesenbd8e6502009-03-03 01:09:07 +000012642 CopyPrecedingStopPoint(I, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000012643 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012644 ++NumSunkInst;
12645 return true;
12646}
12647
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012648
12649/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
12650/// all reachable code to the worklist.
12651///
12652/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
12653/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
12654/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
12655/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
12656/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
12657///
12658static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012659 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012660 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012661 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000012662 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012663 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012664
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012665 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
12666 BB = Worklist.back();
12667 Worklist.pop_back();
12668
12669 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
12670 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012671
12672 DbgInfoIntrinsic *DBI_Prev = NULL;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012673 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
12674 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012675
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012676 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
12677 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
12678 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012679 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst << '\n');
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012680 Inst->eraseFromParent();
12681 continue;
12682 }
12683
12684 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
Owen Anderson50895512009-07-06 18:42:36 +000012685 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, BB->getContext(), TD)) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012686 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: "
12687 << *Inst << '\n');
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012688 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
12689 ++NumConstProp;
12690 Inst->eraseFromParent();
12691 continue;
12692 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000012693
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012694 // If there are two consecutive llvm.dbg.stoppoint calls then
12695 // it is likely that the optimizer deleted code in between these
12696 // two intrinsics.
12697 DbgInfoIntrinsic *DBI_Next = dyn_cast<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(Inst);
12698 if (DBI_Next) {
12699 if (DBI_Prev
12700 && DBI_Prev->getIntrinsicID() == llvm::Intrinsic::dbg_stoppoint
12701 && DBI_Next->getIntrinsicID() == llvm::Intrinsic::dbg_stoppoint) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012702 IC.Worklist.Remove(DBI_Prev);
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012703 DBI_Prev->eraseFromParent();
12704 }
12705 DBI_Prev = DBI_Next;
Zhou Sheng8313ef42009-02-23 10:14:11 +000012706 } else {
12707 DBI_Prev = 0;
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012708 }
12709
Chris Lattner61488a32009-10-11 21:05:34 +000012710 IC.Worklist.Add(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012711 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012712
12713 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
12714 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
12715 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
12716 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
12717 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
12718 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000012719 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012720 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012721 continue;
12722 }
12723 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
12724 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
12725 // See if this is an explicit destination.
12726 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12727 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000012728 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012729 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012730 continue;
12731 }
12732
12733 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
12734 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
12735 continue;
12736 }
12737 }
12738
12739 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12740 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012741 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012742}
12743
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012744bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012745 MadeIRChange = false;
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000012746 TD = getAnalysisIfAvailable<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012747
Daniel Dunbarce63ffb2009-07-25 00:23:56 +000012748 DEBUG(errs() << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
12749 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012750
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012751 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012752 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
12753 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
12754 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012755 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012756 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000012757
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012758 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
12759 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
12760 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
12761 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
12762 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
12763 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
12764 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
12765 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000012766
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012767 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *I << '\n');
Dale Johannesenff278b12009-03-10 21:19:49 +000012768 // A debug intrinsic shouldn't force another iteration if we weren't
12769 // going to do one without it.
12770 if (!isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(I)) {
12771 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012772 MadeIRChange = true;
Dale Johannesenff278b12009-03-10 21:19:49 +000012773 }
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012774 if (!I->use_empty())
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012775 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012776 I->eraseFromParent();
12777 }
12778 }
12779 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012780
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000012781 while (!Worklist.isEmpty()) {
12782 Instruction *I = Worklist.RemoveOne();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012783 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012784
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012785 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012786 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012787 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *I << '\n');
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012788 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
12789 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012790 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012791 continue;
12792 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012793
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012794 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Owen Anderson50895512009-07-06 18:42:36 +000012795 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, F.getContext(), TD)) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012796 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I << '\n');
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012797
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012798 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000012799 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012800 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012801 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012802 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012803 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012804 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012805
Eli Friedmanfd2934f2009-07-15 22:13:34 +000012806 if (TD) {
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000012807 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
Chris Lattner1e19d602009-01-31 07:04:22 +000012808 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
12809 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i))
Owen Anderson50895512009-07-06 18:42:36 +000012810 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE,
12811 F.getContext(), TD))
Chris Lattner1e19d602009-01-31 07:04:22 +000012812 if (NewC != CE) {
Dan Gohmane41a1152009-10-05 16:31:55 +000012813 *i = NewC;
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012814 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner1e19d602009-01-31 07:04:22 +000012815 }
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000012816 }
12817
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012818 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000012819 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012820 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
12821 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
12822 if (UserParent != BB) {
12823 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
12824 // See if the user is one of our successors.
12825 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
12826 if (*SI == UserParent) {
12827 UserIsSuccessor = true;
12828 break;
12829 }
12830
12831 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
12832 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
12833 // otherwise), we can keep going.
12834 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
12835 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
12836 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012837 MadeIRChange |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012838 }
12839 }
12840
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000012841 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it.
12842 Builder->SetInsertPoint(I->getParent(), I);
12843
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000012844#ifndef NDEBUG
12845 std::string OrigI;
12846#endif
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012847 DEBUG(raw_string_ostream SS(OrigI); I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Jeffrey Yasskin43069632009-10-08 00:12:24 +000012848 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Visiting: " << OrigI << '\n');
12849
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012850 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000012851 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012852 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012853 if (Result != I) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012854 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Old = " << *I << '\n'
12855 << " New = " << *Result << '\n');
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012856
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012857 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
12858 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
12859
12860 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012861 Worklist.Add(Result);
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +000012862 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012863
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012864 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
12865 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012866
12867 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
12868 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000012869 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
12870
12871 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
12872 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
12873 ++InsertPos;
12874
12875 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012876
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012877 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000012878 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012879#ifndef NDEBUG
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012880 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI << '\n'
12881 << " New = " << *I << '\n');
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012882#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012883
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012884 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
12885 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012886 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012887 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012888 } else {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012889 Worklist.Add(I);
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +000012890 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012891 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012892 }
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012893 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012894 }
12895 }
12896
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000012897 Worklist.Zap();
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012898 return MadeIRChange;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012899}
12900
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012901
12902bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000012903 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
Owen Andersone922c022009-07-22 00:24:57 +000012904 Context = &F.getContext();
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000012905
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000012906
12907 /// Builder - This is an IRBuilder that automatically inserts new
12908 /// instructions into the worklist when they are created.
12909 IRBuilder<true, ConstantFolder, InstCombineIRInserter>
12910 TheBuilder(F.getContext(), ConstantFolder(F.getContext()),
12911 InstCombineIRInserter(Worklist));
12912 Builder = &TheBuilder;
12913
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012914 bool EverMadeChange = false;
12915
12916 // Iterate while there is work to do.
12917 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000012918 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012919 EverMadeChange = true;
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000012920
12921 Builder = 0;
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012922 return EverMadeChange;
12923}
12924
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000012925FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012926 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012927}